Manual ts4500
Manual ts4500
Manual ts4500
Larry Coyne
Michael Engelbrecht
Simon Browne
Illarion Borisevich
Robert Beiderbeck
Redbooks
International Technical Support Organization
December 2018
SG24-8235-06
Note: Before using this information and the product it supports, read the information in “Notices” on
page vii.
© Copyright International Business Machines Corporation 2014, 2018. All rights reserved.
Note to U.S. Government Users Restricted Rights -- Use, duplication or disclosure restricted by GSA ADP Schedule
Contract with IBM Corp.
Contents
Notices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . vii
Trademarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . viii
Preface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ix
Authors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xi
Now you can become a published author, too . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xii
Comments welcome. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiii
Stay connected to IBM Redbooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiii
Summary of changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv
November 2018, Seventh Edition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv
New information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv
May 2018, minor update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv
January 2018, Sixth Edition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv
New information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv
August 2017, Fifth Edition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvi
New information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvi
July 2016, Fourth Edition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvi
New information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvi
November 2015, Third Edition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvi
New information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvi
January 2015, Second Edition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvi
New information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xvii
Contents v
Help from IBM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
This information was developed for products and services offered in the US. This material might be available
from IBM in other languages. However, you may be required to own a copy of the product or product version in
that language in order to access it.
IBM may not offer the products, services, or features discussed in this document in other countries. Consult
your local IBM representative for information on the products and services currently available in your area. Any
reference to an IBM product, program, or service is not intended to state or imply that only that IBM product,
program, or service may be used. Any functionally equivalent product, program, or service that does not
infringe any IBM intellectual property right may be used instead. However, it is the user’s responsibility to
evaluate and verify the operation of any non-IBM product, program, or service.
IBM may have patents or pending patent applications covering subject matter described in this document. The
furnishing of this document does not grant you any license to these patents. You can send license inquiries, in
writing, to:
IBM Director of Licensing, IBM Corporation, North Castle Drive, MD-NC119, Armonk, NY 10504-1785, US
This information could include technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Changes are periodically made
to the information herein; these changes will be incorporated in new editions of the publication. IBM may make
improvements and/or changes in the product(s) and/or the program(s) described in this publication at any time
without notice.
Any references in this information to non-IBM websites are provided for convenience only and do not in any
manner serve as an endorsement of those websites. The materials at those websites are not part of the
materials for this IBM product and use of those websites is at your own risk.
IBM may use or distribute any of the information you provide in any way it believes appropriate without
incurring any obligation to you.
The performance data and client examples cited are presented for illustrative purposes only. Actual
performance results may vary depending on specific configurations and operating conditions.
Information concerning non-IBM products was obtained from the suppliers of those products, their published
announcements or other publicly available sources. IBM has not tested those products and cannot confirm the
accuracy of performance, compatibility or any other claims related to non-IBM products. Questions on the
capabilities of non-IBM products should be addressed to the suppliers of those products.
Statements regarding IBM’s future direction or intent are subject to change or withdrawal without notice, and
represent goals and objectives only.
This information contains examples of data and reports used in daily business operations. To illustrate them
as completely as possible, the examples include the names of individuals, companies, brands, and products.
All of these names are fictitious and any similarity to actual people or business enterprises is entirely
coincidental.
COPYRIGHT LICENSE:
This information contains sample application programs in source language, which illustrate programming
techniques on various operating platforms. You may copy, modify, and distribute these sample programs in
any form without payment to IBM, for the purposes of developing, using, marketing or distributing application
programs conforming to the application programming interface for the operating platform for which the sample
programs are written. These examples have not been thoroughly tested under all conditions. IBM, therefore,
cannot guarantee or imply reliability, serviceability, or function of these programs. The sample programs are
provided “AS IS”, without warranty of any kind. IBM shall not be liable for any damages arising out of your use
of the sample programs.
The following terms are trademarks or registered trademarks of International Business Machines Corporation,
and might also be trademarks or registered trademarks in other countries.
AIX® IBM Spectrum Scale™ System i®
FICON® IBM Spectrum Storage™ System Storage®
Global Technology Services® IBM z Systems® System z®
HACMP™ Linear Tape File System™ Tivoli®
IBM® OS/400® z Systems®
IBM Spectrum™ POWER® z/OS®
IBM Spectrum Archive™ Redbooks®
IBM Spectrum Protect™ Redbooks (logo) ®
Linux is a trademark of Linus Torvalds in the United States, other countries, or both.
Linear Tape-Open, LTO, Ultrium, the LTO Logo and the Ultrium logo are trademarks of HP, IBM Corp. and
Quantum in the U.S. and other countries.
Microsoft, Windows, and the Windows logo are trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States,
other countries, or both.
Java, and all Java-based trademarks and logos are trademarks or registered trademarks of Oracle and/or its
affiliates.
Other company, product, or service names may be trademarks or service marks of others.
The IBM® TS4500 (TS4500) tape library is a next-generation tape solution that offers higher
storage density and integrated management than previous solutions.
This IBM Redbooks® publication gives you a close-up view of the new IBM TS4500 tape
library. In the TS4500, IBM delivers the density that today’s and tomorrow’s data growth
requires. It has the cost-effectiveness and the manageability to grow with business data
needs, while you preserve existing investments in IBM tape library products.
Now, you can achieve both a low cost per terabyte (TB) and a high TB density per square foot
because the TS4500 can store up to 11 petabytes (PB) of uncompressed data in a single
frame library or scale up to 2 PB per square foot to over 350 PB. The TS4500 offers the
following benefits:
High availability: Dual active accessors with integrated service bays reduce inactive
service space by 40%. The Elastic Capacity option can be used to completely eliminate
inactive service space.
Flexibility to grow: The TS4500 library can grow from the right side and the left side of the
first L frame because models can be placed in any active position.
Increased capacity: The TS4500 can grow from a single L frame up to another 17
expansion frames with a capacity of over 23,000 cartridges.
High-density (HD) generation 1 frames from the TS3500 library can be redeployed in a
TS4500.
Capacity on demand (CoD): CoD is supported through entry-level, intermediate, and
base-capacity configurations.
Advanced Library Management System (ALMS): ALMS supports dynamic storage
management, which enables users to create and change logical libraries and configure
any drive for any logical library.
Support for IBM TS1160 while also supporting TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140 tape drive:
The TS1160 gives organizations an easy way to deliver fast access to data, improve
security, and provide long-term retention, all at a lower cost than disk solutions. The
TS1160 offers high-performance, flexible data storage with support for data encryption.
Also, this enhanced fifth-generation drive can help protect investments in tape automation
by offering compatibility with existing automation.
The new TS1160 Tape Drive Model 60E delivers a dual 10 Gb or 25 Gb Ethernet host
attachment interface that is optimized for cloud-based and hyperscale environments.
The TS1160 Tape Drive Model 60F delivers a native data rate of 400 MBps, the same
load/ready, locate speeds, and access times as the TS1155, and includes dual-port 16 Gb
Fibre Channel support.
Support of the IBM Linear Tape-Open (LTO) Ultrium 8 tape drive: The LTO Ultrium 8
offering represents significant improvements in capacity, performance, and reliability over
the previous generation, LTO Ultrium 7, while still protecting your investment in the
previous technology.
Support of LTO 8 Type M cartridge (M8): The LTO Program is introducing a new capability
with LTO-8 drives. The ability of the LTO-8 drive to write 9 TB on a brand new LTO-7
cartridge instead of 6 TB as specified by the LTO-7 format. Such a cartridge is called an
LTO-7 initialized LTO-8 Type M cartridge.
This book describes the TS4500 components, feature codes, specifications, supported tape
drives, encryption, new integrated management console (IMC), and command-line interface
(CLI). You learn how to accomplish the following specific tasks:
Improve storage density with increased expansion frame capacity up to 2.4 times and
support 33% more tape drives per frame.
Manage storage by using the ALMS feature.
Improve business continuity and disaster recovery with dual active accessor, automatic
control path failover, and data path failover.
Help ensure security and regulatory compliance with tape-drive encryption and Write
Once Read Many (WORM) media.
Support IBM LTO Ultrium 8, 7, 6, and 5, IBM TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140 tape
drives.
Provide a flexible upgrade path for users who want to expand their tape storage as their
needs grow.
Reduce the storage footprint and simplify cabling with 10 U of rack space on top of the
library.
This guide is for anyone who wants to understand more about the IBM TS4500 tape library. It
is particularly suitable for IBM clients, IBM Business Partners, IBM specialist sales
representatives, and technical specialists.
Preface xi
Robert Beiderbeck is an IBM Senior Accredited Specialist for
Product Service profession and works as a Team Leader for
the EMEA RMSS Product Field Engineering (PFE) group in
Germany. He joined IBM in 1989 as a Customer Service
Representative for Mainframe (z Systems) and worked later in
the z Systems Hardware Support Center, responsible for
Server, ESCON, and IBM FICON® Switches and
Infrastructure. Robert then became a Storage Specialist for
Tape Libraries, VTS, and Drives in the field before he joined
second-level support in 2002. His areas of expertise include
Enterprise Tape Systems, such as TS7700, TS3500, 3494,
VTS (P2P), and 3590/3592 Drives and Control Units.
Find out more about the residency program, browse the residency index, and apply online at:
ibm.com/redbooks/residencies.html
We want our books to be as helpful as possible. Send us your comments about this book or
other IBM Redbooks publications in one of the following ways:
Use the online Contact us review Redbooks form:
ibm.com/redbooks
Send your comments by email:
[email protected]
Mail your comments:
IBM Corporation, International Technical Support Organization
Dept. HYTD Mail Station P099
2455 South Road
Poughkeepsie, NY 12601-5400
Preface xiii
xiv IBM TS4500 R5 Tape Library Guide
Summary of changes
Summary of changes for IBM TS4500 R5 Tape Library Guide, SG24-8235, as created or
updated in December 2018.
This section describes the technical changes that were made in this edition of the book and in
previous editions. This edition might also include minor corrections and editorial changes that
are not identified.
New information
The book includes the following new information:
TS1150 model 60E
TS1160 model 60F
New media JE, JM, and JV
New information
The book includes the following new information:
LTO Ultrium 8 tape drive (Model 3588 F8C).
LTO 8 Type M cartridge (M8): The LTO Program is introducing a new capability with
LTO-8 drives. The ability of the LTO-8 drive to write 9 TB on a brand new LTO-7 cartridge
instead of 6 TB as specified by the LTO-7 format. Such a cartridge is called an LTO-7
initialized LTO-8 Type M cartridge.
New information
The book includes the following new information:
TS1155 model 55E
TS1155 model 55F
New commands for Ethernet drives
New information
The book includes the following new information:
High availability with dual active accessor and Elastic Capacity option
Mainframe-ready for TS7700 attachment
Integrated TS7700 Backend Switches
Support for external TSSC/IMC
Flexible growth options with new flex track design
Encryption options
New information
The book includes the following new information:
IBM TS1070 tape drive (Model 3588 F7C)
Up to 128 tape drives
Scalability to 18 frames
Redeployment of S24 and S54 frames from TS3500 to TS4500
Mixed media types within the same TS4500 library
Automatic media verification
Flexible remote authentication
Primary control system failover
SNMP query configuration
The TS4500 tape library combines reliable, automated tape handling and storage with high
performance in an open systems and enterprise environment. Incorporating the IBM Linear
Tape-Open (LTO) Ultrium tape and 3592 drives, the TS4500 tape library offers outstanding
retrieval performance with typical cartridge move times of less than 3 seconds.
The TS4500, installed with the High Availability (HA) option, provides dual active accessors
for redundancy, and can double the robot performance during tape move operations. The HA
option on TS4500 has no dedicated service bays and provides the Elastic Capacity option for
the use of the storage slots in these integrated service bays.
The TS4500 tape library can be deployed as a single frame library and upgraded to a
maximum of 18 frames, with a combination of LTO and 3592 frames. This single frame library
can be partitioned into multiple logical libraries. This feature makes the TS4500 tape library
an excellent choice for consolidating tape workloads from multiple heterogeneous open
systems servers.
The TS4500 protects investment by providing for redeployment of S24 and S54 frames from
the TS3500 onto the TS4500.
The library provides outstanding reliability and redundancy through the provision of redundant
power supplies in each drive frame, control and data path failover, dual grippers within the
cartridge accessor, and dual active accessors. Library and drive firmware can be upgraded
nondisruptively, without interrupting normal operations. Encryption is supported on the
following tape drives:
LTO Ultrium 8 tape drive (Model 3588 F8C)
LTO Ultrium 7 tape drive (Model 3588 F7C)
LTO Ultrium 6 tape drive (Model 3588 F6C)
LTO Ultrium 5 tape drive (Model 3588 F5C)
TS1160 tape drive (Model 3592 60E)
TS4500 Release 4.1 added the LTO Ultrium 8 tape drive (Model 3588 F8C) function.
TS4500 Release 3 added the following functions, which are described in this chapter:
HA with dual active accessor and Elastic Capacity option
Mainframe-ready for TS7700 attachment
Integrated TS7700 Backend Switches
Support for external TSSC/Integrated management console (IMC)
Flexible growth options with new flex track design
Support for 4 EKM servers on each logical library
With TS4500 Release 2, the following new functions are supported over and above the first
release:
Automatic media verification
Flexible remote authentication
Primary control system failover
Mixed media types within the same TS4500 library
Scalability to 18 frames
Up to 128 tape drives
SNMP query configuration
Redeployment of S24 and S54 frames from TS3500 to TS4500
Figure 1-1 shows a three-frame version of the TS4500 tape library. An individual library can
consist of one L frame and up to 17 expansion frames, and it can include up to 128 tape
drives with more than 23,000 tape cartridges, as shown in Figure 1-2 on page 5.
L25, D25, S25, and 3592 tape drives 17,550 351 petabytes (PB)
S24
L55, D55, S55, and LTO tape drives 23,170 278 petabytes (PB)
S54
Note: The maximum native capacity figures are based on library configurations of one base frame with
all LTO-8 or TS1160 tape drives, and 17 storage-only HD frames.
Eight types of frames are supported in the current TS4500 tape library range. Each frame is
identified by a three-character model number (L25, D25, L55, D55, S25, S55, S24, and S54),
which describes the nature of the frame.
The TS4500 tape library is built from a single frame model that is called the base frame. The
scalability of the library allows an increase in capacity by adding up to 17 frames, which are
called expansion frames. The frames join side-by-side and can grow to the left or right of the
base frame. All frames can be supported by a single cartridge accessor, or by dual active
accessors, with the HA feature installed. The TS4500 tape library can contain a mix of 3592
and LTO frames.
The TS4500 tape library supports first generation (S54 and S24) frames (HD1) and
second-generation high-density (HD2) frames. HD2 frames, like the first-generation HD1
frames, offer increased capacity without increasing the frame size or required floor space, by
using high-density storage slots for tape cartridges.
Generation 1 HD frames from the TS3500 (Model S24 and S54) can be redeployed into a
TS4500. These HD1 frames must be installed to the right of the Lx5 frame and require FC
1742 to be ordered for each S24 or S54 (Sx4) frames before they can exist in a TS4500
library string.
The L25 and L55 (Lx5) frames and D25 and D55 (Dx5) frames are HD2, drive-capable
frames, which means that they contain high-density cartridge storage slots, and slots to
house up to 16 tape drives. The S25, S55 (Sx5) HD2 frames and the S54, S24 (Sx4) HD1
frames are storage-only frames, which means that they contain high-density cartridge storage
slots, but no tape drives. All HD frames provide internal light-emitting diode (LED) lighting.
The TS4500 also supports adding a top rack frame. The top rack, 3584 Model TR1, provides
an extra 10U of rack space on any frame in a library without requiring more floor space.
Table 1-2 lists the frames that are supported by the library and their specific media type and
capacity.
L25 Base frame 3592 Up to 12 tape Up to 16 tape Equipped with two I/O
drives and 550 drives and 660 stations and two 16-slot
storage slots storage slots magazines
Optionally equipped with top
rack (Model TR1)
L55 Base frame LTO Up to 12 tape Up to 16 tape Equipped with two I/O
drives and 730 drives and 882 stations and two 18-slot
storage slots storage slots magazines
Optionally equipped with top
rack (Model TR1)
S25 Storage-only 3592 798 storage slots 1,000 storage slots Optionally equipped with top
expansion rack (Model TR1)
frame
S55 Storage-only LTO 1,054 storage slots 1,320 storage slots Optionally equipped with top
expansion rack (Model TR1)
frame
S24 Storage-only 3592 Not supported 1,000 storage slots Optionally equipped with top
expansion rack (Model TR1)
frame
S54 Storage-only LTO Not supported 1,320 storage slots Optionally equipped with top
expansion rack (Model TR1)
frame
1.2.1 TS4500 tape library frames for IBM LTO Ultrium Fibre Channel drives
The TS4500 tape library models L55 and D55 integrate the HD2 versions of the LTO-8,
LTO-7, LTO-6, and LTO-5 (8 Gbps dual-port Fibre Channel) tape drives. The TS4500 models
S55 and S54 are high capacity storage-only frames for LTO cartridge slots.
The Model L55 frame includes the frame control assembly with two power supplies (for
redundancy), an optimized dual-gripper cartridge accessor, on-demand storage slot capacity,
and two I/O stations with two 18-slot magazines.
HD2 expansion frames can be added to the left or right of the L55 frame. HD1 frames can be
added only to the right side of L55 frame (see Figure 1-3).
Many CoD feature codes exist for the L55 frame, and the number of available slots depends
on the frame position.
The Intermediate Capacity feature (FC 1643) gives a maximum total number of usable
cartridge slots of 200. This feature is a prerequisite for the Base Capacity on Demand (FC
1644), which gives the maximum capacity of 400 cartridge slots. FC 1644 is required to
attach an optional expansion frame. Both FC 1643 and FC 1644 are prerequisites to install
the HD CoD for L55 (FC 1648), which gives the maximum capacity of 730 - 882 slots.
Depending on the frame position, a maximum of 16 LTO drives can be installed. Four
generations of HD2-compatible LTO drives exist: the LTO Ultrium 8 tape drive (Model 3588
F8C), LTO Ultrium 7 tape drive (Model 3588 F7C), LTO Ultrium 6 tape drive (Model 3588
F6C), and the LTO Ultrium 5 tape drive (Model 3588 F5C), which can be installed in the L55
frame. Drive slots are fixed. Adding drives to the L55 frame does not affect the number of
available storage slots.
The L55 frame comes standard with two I/O stations. Each I/O station houses a cartridge
magazine that allows individual cartridge handling to be performed independently of the tape
library. The cartridge magazine for each I/O station on LTO frames can hold up to 18
cartridges, which provides a total of 36 I/O slots.
The TS4500 tape library Model L55 imports or exports cartridges from the library, without
requiring reinventory, or interruption of library operations. The lockable library door can be
opened for bulk-loading LTO tape cartridges. Reinventory of the cartridges in tier 0 and tier 1
is performed in less than 60 seconds per frame, each time that the library door is closed. A
bar code reader that is mounted on the autochanger is used to scan the cartridge bar code
labels during inventory.
Important: If a bulk load is performed, the top two rows on tier 1 (drive side wall) must
remain empty to allow for the initial inventory. Place only the cartridges in the frame that
has the front door open. Do not insert cartridges into slots in an adjacent frame.
On an HD frame after initial inventor, the inventory checks tier 1 bar code labels only, and
checks the other tier labels only if tier 1 changed.
A door lock is included to restrict physical access to the cartridges in the library, and a door
open sensor is equipped to prevent accessor movement while the door is open.
Note: The left and right side doors also contain the door lock and open sensor.
Included in the L55 frame is the IMC, which is a built-in platform for tools that are used to
manage the TS4500 tape library. The IMC, which includes an LCD panel and a keyboard with
a touchpad, can be mounted on either end of your TS4500 tape library. For more information
about the IMC and other components, see 4.1, “Integrated management console” on
page 184.
The D55 frame cannot be installed on its own. It must be connected to a library with a base
frame. A maximum of 18 frames, including the L55 frame, can be connected, as shown in
Figure 1-2 on page 5.
Note: The combined number of D55 or D25 drive frames that can be installed in a TS4500
library is limited to seven.
The number of extra LTO cartridge storage slots per D55 frame ranges is 500 - 970. With the
minimum configuration, only 500 slots are available for use. More slots can be enabled by
installing a capacity on demand (CoD) license key.
The base capacity on a D55 frame gives the maximum capacity of 500 cartridge slots.
FC 1644 must be installed on the L55 frame with FC 9002 or FC 9003, and the corresponding
prerequisite feature code, to attach a D55 expansion frame, as described in 1.4, “Feature
codes for the TS4500” on page 52. The HD CoD for D55 (FC 1650) gives the maximum
capacity of 730 - 970 slots, depending on the frame position.
Depending on the frame position, the maximum number of LTO drives that can be installed is
16. As with the L55 frame, the following generations of HD2-compatible LTO drives can be
installed in the D55 frame:
The LTO Ultrium 8 tape drive (Model 3588 F8C)
The LTO Ultrium 7 tape drive (Model 3588 F7C)
Drive slots are fixed. Adding drives to the D55 frame does not affect the number of available
storage slots.
Figure 1-5 on page 10 shows the D55 frame with drive and HD slots.
Two extra I/O stations can be installed in any Dx5 expansion frame by ordering FC 1652. This
feature installs two I/O stations in a drive expansion frame. Each extra pair of I/O stations
increases the maximum insert/eject throughput for the library. The maximum cartridge
capacity for expansion frames with two I/O stations is reduced by 88 cartridges for the Model
D55.
The position and configuration of the frame, the number of I/O slots, and the installation of
capacity on demand (CoD) features all affect the total available storage capacity of the D55.
Table 1-4 shows the available storage capacity, which is based on possible frame positions
and configurations and capacity for each Tier.
1.2.2 TS4500 tape library frames for IBM 3592 Fibre Channel drives
The TS4500 tape library models L25 and D25 integrate the TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140
tape drives. The TS4500 Model S25 is a high-capacity, storage-only frame for 3592 slots.
The Model L25 frame includes the Frame Control Assembly (FCA) with two power supplies
(for redundancy), an optimized dual-gripper cartridge accessor, on-demand storage slot
capacity, and two I/O stations with two 16-slot magazines.
The HD2 expansion frame can be added to the left or right of the L25 frame. HD1 frames can
be added only to the right side of the L25 frame.
The Intermediate Capacity feature (FC 1643) gives a maximum of 200 usable cartridge slots.
This feature is a prerequisite for the Base Capacity on Demand feature
(FC 1644), which gives the maximum capacity of 400 cartridge slots. FC 1644 is required to
attach an optional expansion frame. FC 1644 is a prerequisite to install the HD CoD for L25
(FC 1647), which offers the maximum capacity of 550 - 660 slots.
Depending on the frame positions, a maximum of 16 3592 drives can be installed. Four
generations of HD2-compatible 3592 drives, the TS1160 (3592 60F), TS1155 (3592 55F and
55E), TS1150 (3592 E08), and TS1140 (3592 E07) tape drives, are supported in the L25
frame. Drive slots are fixed. Adding drives to the L25 frame does not affect the number of
available storage slots.
The position and configuration of the frame and the installation of capacity on demand (CoD)
features affect the total available capacity of the L25. Table 1-5 on page 13 lists the available
storage capacity, which is based on possible frame positions and configurations and capacity
for each Tier.
The L25 frame comes standard with two I/O stations. Each I/O station houses a cartridge
magazine that allows importing or exporting cartridges from the library without requiring
reinventory or an interruption of library operations. The cartridge magazine for each I/O
station on 3592 frames can hold up to 16 cartridges, which provides a total of 32 I/O slots.
The lockable library door can be opened for bulk-loading IBM LTO Ultrium tape cartridges.
Reinventory of the cartridges in tier 0 and tier 1 is performed in less than 60 seconds per
frame each time that the library door is closed. A bar code reader that is mounted on the
gripper is used to scan the cartridge bar code labels during inventory.
Important: If a bulk load is performed, the top two rows on tier 1 (drive side wall) must
remain empty to allow for the initial inventory.
On an HD frame, the inventory checks tier 0 and tier 1 bar code labels only, and the inventory
checks the other tier labels only if tier 1 changed.
A door lock is included to restrict physical access to cartridges in the library. A door open
sensor also is equipped to prevent accessor movement while the door is open.
Included in the L25 frame is the IMC, which is a built-in platform for tools that are used to
manage the TS4500 tape library. The IMC, which includes an LCD panel and a keyboard with
a touchpad, can be mounted on either end of your TS4500 tape library. For more information
about the IMC and other components, see Chapter 4, “TS4500 management graphical user
interface” on page 183.
Important: The combined number of allowed D55 or D25 frames in a TS4500 library is
limited to seven.
The number of extra 3592 cartridge storage slots per D25 frame is 500 - 740. With the
minimum configuration, only 500 slots are available for use.
The HD CoD for D25 (FC 1649) gives the maximum capacity of 660 - 740 slots, depending on
the frame position.
Depending on the frame position, a maximum of 16 3592 drives that can be installed. Three
generations of HD2-compatible 3592 drives, the TS1160 (3592 60E and 3592 60F), TS1155
(3592 55E and 55F), TS1150 (3592 E08), and TS1140 (3592 E07) tape drives, are supported
in the D25 frame. Drive slots are fixed. Adding drives to the D25 frame does not affect the
number of available storage slots.
Two extra I/O stations can be installed in any Dx5 expansion frame by ordering FC 1652. This
feature installs two I/O stations in one expansion frame. Each extra pair of I/O stations
increases the maximum insert/eject throughput for the library. The maximum cartridge
capacity for expansion frames with two I/O stations is reduced by 80 cartridges for the Model
D25 frame.
The position and configuration of the frame, the number of I/O slots, and the installation of
CoD features all affect the total available storage capacity of the D55. Table 1-6 lists the
available storage capacity based on possible frame positions and configurations and capacity
for each Tier.
These frames are designed to increase storage capacity greatly without increasing the frame
size or required floor space.
The HD slots contain tape cartridges in a tiered architecture. The cartridge, which is
immediately accessible in the HD slot, is a tier 1 cartridge (behind that tier is tier 2, and so
on).
The maximum tier in an LTO HD slot is tier 5. The maximum tier in a 3592 HD slot is tier 4
because the 3592 tape cartridge is slightly longer than the LTO cartridge. The single-deep
slots on the door side of HD frames are referred to as tier 0 slots.
Figure 1-8 The HD frame (left) and top-down view of a row in an HD frame (right)
These generation 1 HD frames can be redeployed into a TS4500 if they are installed to the
right of the Lx5 frame. You must install FC 1742 before the frames can be added to a TS4500
library string. This feature code replaces the TS3500 cards to be supported on the TS4500,
as shown in Figure 1-9.
The TS3500 tape library models S24 and S54 frames are high-density (HD) version 1
storage-only expansion frames, which were attached to TS3500 tape libraries and frames.
The Model S54 expansion frame is for LTO data cartridges. Up to 17 Model S54 expansion
frames can be added to the right of the Lx5 frame of the TS4500 tape library Model L55 base
frame to increase LTO cartridge storage. Each Model S54 frame supports up to 1,320 LTO
cartridge slots.
The HD1 models S24 and S54 can be added to any TS4500 expansion frame, if the
expansion frame is added to the right of the Lx5 frame, up to a total of 18 expansion frames,
including the Lx5 frame.
Note: The HD1 models S24 and S54 cannot be installed to the left of the Lx5 frame and
cannot be installed as the right-most frame in a dual accessor tape library.
Attention: The HD slots use a constant force spring to maintain forward pressure on the
tape cartridges. Use caution when you insert or remove cartridges from the HD slots.
In HD frames, the cartridge accessor performs a shuffle operation to access the cartridges
that are stored in tier 2 and higher. A shuffle is the process of moving cartridges in lower tier
into the gripper, or other available slots, to access cartridges in higher tier (tier 2 or higher). To
reduce shuffle operations and take advantage of repeated accesses of certain cartridges, the
role of cartridge cache is assigned to all single-deep (tier 0) slots in an HD library.
To maintain efficient shuffle operations, the library uses load balancing to store cartridges
across all HD slots in the library string. Therefore, all HD slots are filled to a minimum tier level
until that tier is full across the library.
First-generation HD (HD1) frames can be installed to the right side of an Lx5 frame only.
The position and configuration of the frame and the installation of CoD features affect the total
available storage capacity of the S25 and S55 frames. Table 1-7 lists the available storage
capacity based on possible frame positions and configurations.
The integrated service bays replace the existing HA frame and Service Bay B frames that are
used on the TS3500. The integrated service bays allows a section of a frame to be used for
servicing an accessor while the remaining portion of the frame is still available for active
storage and drives. Accessor service must be performed through the side, by opening the
side doors of integrated service bays. Any HD2 frame can be an integrated service bay.
Figure 1-11 shows the HA feature that shipped in a new D25 frame.
Restriction: The left or A side integrated service bay (ISB) allows cartridges to be
populated in storage columns 9 and 10, while drives can only be populated in drive column
4.
The right or B side ISB allows cartridges to be populated in storage columns 1, 2, 3, and 4,
while drives can only be populated in drive columns 1 and 2. The I/O stations are
accessible in the right integrated service bay.
An integrated service bay allows a minimum dual accessor system of only two frames.
Note: I/O stations are not accessible in the left integrated service bay; therefore, an L25 or
L55 frame cannot be used as a left integrated service bay. The frame that ships with the
HA option can be installed on the left side if required because no dedicated service bays
are on that side. The new accessor must be installed in the frame on the right side.
With dual active accessors, certain storage slots are only available to a single accessor, and
they are unavailable during accessor service. The ability to use these slots is optional, and
they can be enabled or disabled on the management interface. The following modes are
available for the Elastic Capacity option:
Do not use
Use for temporary overflow
Use for maximum capacity
Do not use
In this mode, the TS4500 does not use the Elastic Capacity slots for media storage, so all
media is usable when only one accessor is available. Tier T10 - T15 slots are not used.
Note: “Use for maximum capacity” is the default setting if the setting is not changed.
1.2.5 Mainframe-ready
From FW release 3, the TS4500 is supported on IBM z/OS systems with an attached
TS7700. The TS7700 requires FW release 4 and higher to attach to a TS4500.
To provide this support, the TS4500 must have two integrated 16 Gb Fibre Channel (FC)
switches, which can be installed in the bottom of a L25 or D25 frame, as shown in Figure 1-13
on page 22.
The TS4500 management graphical user interface (GUI) supports the preset TS7700 logical
library and the use of an external TSSC/IMC.
Note: The integrated FC switches do not require extra power feeds to the TS4500. The
integrated FC switches use bifurcated power cords that are provided with the mounting kit
hardware for the switches. These power cords connect internally to the existing TS4500
Power Distribution Units.
Note: The external TSSC can also be a TSSC/IMC inside another TS4500. This
configuration requires that you install FC 2704 on the Lx5 frame. FC 2704 provides a
26-port switch to allow connection to up to 24 extra devices to share the TSSC/IMC.
Only one TSSC/IMC can be configured for call home: the external TSSC/IMC or by using a
internal IMC.
The optional top rack, as shown in Figure 1-15, reduces the storage footprint and simplifies
cabling by providing extra rack space above the library for power distribution units (PDUs),
Fibre Channel (FC) switches, tape data movers, or IBM Spectrum Archive nodes.
A top rack is installed in the field by an IBM service support representative (SSR) on one or
more frames of a TS4500 tape library. The top rack, and any components that are housed in
the rack, are supported and serviced independently of the TS4500 tape library.
Feature Code (FC) 1750, Top Rack End Covers, is required for the left and right ends of one
or more adjacent top racks. This feature is required for only the first top rack that is ordered
when multiple top racks are ordered for adjacent frames.
FC 1751, Power Distribution Unit (PDU), can be ordered optionally for any top rack. Up to two
of FC 1751 can be ordered for any top rack. The first PDU does not use any of the 10U rack
space. A second PDU, for redundancy, uses 1U of rack space. One power cord feature, FC
9954 - FC 9959 or FC 9966, is required for each PDU that is ordered.
Important: The top rack is treated as an independent rack space, and it is not tied to the
service or support of the tape library.
Each available component in the front and side of the frame is shown in Figure 1-17.
Figure 1-17 TS4500 components that are available from the front of the frame
1 Library frames
2 Rail system
3 Cartridge accessor
4 Accessor controller
7 Front door
9 I/O stations
The components that are shown in Figure 1-19 are listed in Table 1-9.
14 Patch panel
The components that are shown in Figure 1-20 are listed in Table 1-10.
16 Display panel
17 I/O stations
Library frames
The base frame (Lx5 models) and the expansion frames (Dx5, Sx5, and Sx5 models) are the
building blocks of the library. Each frame contains a rail system, high-density cartridge
storage slots, and internal LED lighting. The Lx5 and Dx5 frames also contain slots for up to
16 tape drives.
The new style of cable requires no tools to install or replace. It is stacked in a new guide that
is designed with two-chambers, which separate signal and power wires. Accessor A uses the
top guide and accessor B uses the bottom guide, as shown in Figure 1-22.
These cables plug into the same frame. You are required to move them only if you add frames
to the left.
Important: When you add the new HA feature to an TS4500, you must order FC 2071 or
FC 2072 for each frame in addition to ordering the correct length flex track cable.
Cartridge accessor
The cartridge accessor moves cartridges between the storage slots, tape drives, and the I/O
station of the TS4500 tape library. If the HA option is installed, two accessors exist: accessor
A and accessor B. Functionally, accessor A and accessor B are identical. They have the
same hardware components, except for a bottom bumper and the location of the X home
sensor moving to the right side of accessor B.
Pivot assembly
This group of parts provides a mounting platform for the gripper mechanism and the bar code
reader. This assembly can rotate 180° around the vertical axis, as shown in Figure 1-24.
An Auxiliary Lighting Element (ALE) assists the bar code reader. The ALE provides light to
assist the bar code reader to scan labels correctly. The ALE connects to the top of the bottom
gripper.
The inventory update determines whether cartridges are added to or removed from the
library, or moved within the library. The bar code assembly, calibration assembly reader, and
ALE are shown in Figure 1-26.
Up to 12 drives can be installed in an Lx5 or Dx5 frame that is in frame position 1 (the leftmost
frame) of the library. Up to 16 drives can be installed in each Lx5 or Dx5 frame that is in frame
position 2 or higher. Within a HA configuration the maximum number of drives that can be
installed in the last frame is eight, if the frame is a Lx5 or Dx5 frame.
LTO and 3592 tape drives cannot be mixed in the same frame, but the LTO and 3592 frames
can be mixed in the same library. You can identify a drive by examining the logo at the front of
the drive canister or by inspecting the label at the rear of the drive canister. For more
information about these drives, see Chapter 2, “TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592
tape drives” on page 65.
Note: No drives are installed in the storage-only frames (models S25, S24, S55, and S54).
Table 1-11 Tape drives that are supported by the TS4500 tape library
Type of Speed of Native Native capacity Other information
drive connection data rate read/write
IBM LTO 8 Gbps Fibre 360 MBps 12 TB Known as the LTO-8 tape drive,
Ultrium 8 (10.91 TiB) Model 3588 F8C, TS1080
IBM LTO 8 Gbps Fibre 300 MBps 6 TB Known as the LTO-7 tape drive,
Ultrium 7 (5.46 TiB) Model 3588 F7C, TS1070
IBM LTO 8 Gbps Fibre 160 MBps 2.5 TB Known as the LTO-6 tape drive,
Ultrium 6 (2.27 TiB) Model 3588 F6C, TS1060
IBM LTO 8 Gbps Fibre 140 MBps 1.5 TB Known as the LTO-5 tape drive,
Ultrium 5 (1.36 TiB) Model 3588 F5C, TS1050
IBM TS1160 16 Gbps Fibre 400 MBps 900 GB (.82 TiB) Known as the 3592 60E or 3592
for model 60F with JK 60F tape drive
5 TB (3.63 TiB)
10 or 25 Gbps with JM
Optical 7 TB (6.37 TiB)
Ethernet for with JC/JY
model 60E 15 TB (13.64 TiB)
with JD/JZ
20 TB (18.19 TiB)
with JE/JV
IBM TS1155 8 Gbps Fibre 360 MBps 900 GB (.82 TiB) Known as the 3592 55E or 3592
for model 55F with JK 55F tape drive
3 TB (2.73 TiB)
10 Gbps with JL
Optical 7 TB (6.37 TiB)
Ethernet for with JC/JY
model 55E 15 TB (13.64 TiB)
with JD/JZ
IBM TS1150 8 Gbps Fibre 360 MBps 900 GB (.82 TiB) Known as the 3592 EH8 tape
with JK drive
2 TB (1.82 TiB)
with JL
7 TB (6.37 TiB)
with JC/JY
10 TB (9.1 TiB)
with JD/JZ c
IBM TS1140 8 Gbps Fibre 250 MBps 500 GB (.48 TiB) Known as the 3592 EH7 tape
with JK drive
1.6 TB (1.46 TiB)
with JB/JX
4 TB (3.6 TiB)
with JC/JY
Front door
The front door contains single cartridge storage slots on the inside of the door that are
referred to as tier 0 slots. Two I/O stations are installed on the front door of the base frame.
Optionally, two extra I/O stations can be installed on the front door of any Dx5 frame. The
library’s front door has a key lock. The key lock is the same for every front door, and the keys
are shipped with the library. The front door is shown in Figure 1-20 on page 29.
Note: The side doors of the base frames (Lx5) also have a key lock, which is the same key
lock that is used for the front door.
To service the accessor, it must be removed from the TS4500 by using the side door. This
action is a concurrent action with the second accessor that is used for move commands. This
process is simple because the end stops and track cable can be removed without any tools.
I/O stations
Two I/O stations on the front door of the base frame enable the insertion or removal of tape
cartridges without requiring the library to reinventory the frame. Optionally, two additional I/O
stations can be installed on any Dx5 expansion frame. The I/O station is universal, and either
LTO or 3592 magazines can be installed in it.
Cartridges can be inserted or removed by using the I/O stations while the TS4500 tape library
performs other operations without requiring an inventory.
The TS4500 tape library base frames (models L25 and L55) come with two I/O stations. Each
I/O station houses a cartridge magazine so that individual cartridges can be handled
independently of the tape library. Consider the following points:
A cartridge magazine for LTO frames can hold up to 18 cartridges.
A cartridge magazine for 3592 frames can hold up to 16 cartridges.
On libraries with LTO and 3592 frames, the first Dx5 frame (different from the Lx5) can have
I/O stations that ship with magazines for the different drive type. The LTO and 3592
magazines can be installed on any I/O station.
Magazines for different media types can also be ordered by using FC 1628 for LTO and
FC 1629 for 3592.
When a magazine is removed from an I/O station, it is necessary to engage the safety lock
until the magazine is placed on an accessible surface. It is then necessary to unlock the
magazine to insert or remove cartridges. Attempting to insert or remove cartridges while the
magazine safety lock is engaged might damage the magazine or the cartridges.
After a magazine is reinserted into an I/O station, it is necessary to unlock the magazine so
that the accessor can retrieve cartridges. The I/O doors do not close correctly if the magazine
is not unlocked.
Two additional I/O stations can be installed in any Dx5 expansion frame by ordering FC 1652.
This feature installs two I/O stations in one expansion frame. Each additional pair of I/O
stations increases the maximum insert/eject throughput for the library. The maximum
cartridge capacity for expansion frames with two I/O stations is reduced by 80 cartridges for
Model D25 and by 88 cartridges for Model D55. Storage-only frames (models Sx5) do not
support I/O stations.
You can remotely use the I/O station action menu, which is available from the System page of
the TS4500 management GUI, to open and close the I/O station doors. At the library, you can
press the eject button (which is numbered 1 in Figure 1-35 on page 41) to open and close the
doors. When the doors are open, it is possible to manually remove and replace the cartridge
magazine to insert or remove cartridges.
When the doors are closed, the cartridge accessor can access the cartridges. The lock status
LED that is next to the eject button (numbered 2 in Figure 1-35 on page 41) indicates that the
I/O station is locked because the accessor can insert or remove cartridges. Do not attempt to
open the I/O station when the lock status indicator is illuminated.
Important: Do not tilt the magazine during installation. Not tiling the magazine avoids
pushing magazine through the I/O station and obstructing the accessor.
Important: Use only the eject button (which is numbered 1 in Figure 1-35 on page 41) or
the management GUI to open and close the I/O station doors. Do not attempt to open or
close the doors manually.
Table 1-12 I/O station (numbers correspond to Figure 1-35 on page 41)
Number Function
1 Eject button.
2 Open/close state.
Off: Normal state.
Blinking: Transitional state. Whenever the button is pushed, it blinks and goes off when the
doors open, and it blinks and comes back on as a solid light if it is locked by a “code”.
On solid: Locked.
4 No magazine is present.
On solid: No magazine is present.
Each I/O station slot has a unique address to indicate its physical location. The I/O station slot
address consists of two values: a frame number and a row number.
After you close the I/O station doors, the library automatically moves the cartridges into
storage slots. How each cartridge is assigned to a logical library depends on the configured
VOLSER ranges. For more information, see Figure 1-36 on page 43. The state of the
cartridge is shown in bold.
The IMC, which includes an LCD panel and a keyboard with a touchpad, can be mounted on
either end of your TS4500 tape library. A library controller card (LCC) and a power source are
required within that end frame or within the adjacent frame. Alternatively, Feature Code 2737
allows for the IMC to be mounted on a non-powered end frame; that is, more than one frame
away from a powered frame. This feature can be installed during the installation of expansion
frames in an initial library installation, or later when expansion frames are added to a library.
The IMC comes preinstalled with a system console application, which is a set of software
tools that are used for local service and remote support of the attached TS4500 tape library.
The system console application enables the IMC to provide service console capabilities, such
as broadband Call Home.
The TS4500 management GUI runs on a web browser in kiosk mode on the IMC. Kiosk mode
means that the menu bar, address bar, and stop and reload buttons of the browser are
disabled. In addition, it is not possible to use bookmarks or multiple browser windows.
For more information about the IMC, see Chapter 4, “TS4500 management graphical user
interface” on page 183.
A new Model Sx5 feature (FC 2737) provides a separate IMC power source, which enables
the IMC to be installed on an Sx5 frame where the power cable is not long enough to reach a
Dx5 or Lx5 frame. The feature includes instructions for moving the IMC PDU from the Lx5
frame to the Sx5 frame with the IMC, and for attaching a separately ordered power cord to a
client outlet at that Sx5 frame. The feature also includes two extremely long Ethernet cables
to connect the IMC to the Lx5 frame LCC at any frame position.
The LCC has redundancy capability. In multiple drive frame configurations, the library
negotiates the primary LCC, which controls the management functions.
During the power-up process, a selection process occurs to select the primary LCC. The
selection process considers the LCC with the best database capabilities and the best
hardware capabilities. The hardware capabilities relate to I/O station control and frame types.
Each LCC knows how many LCCs are in the system. If only one LCC is in the system, this
LCC becomes the primary LCC. If any primary LCC fails, any LCC card can resume
operations as the primary LCC.
Note: Every Lx5 frame and a Dx5 frame with drives installed have a LCC installed. Sx5
frames or Dx5 frames without drives do not have a LCC installed.
Note: From firmware version R1.3 and higher, two LFI cards must be installed in every
frame.
Note: Do not use tools to tighten the screws on the LFI card connectors. The use of tools
can result in cables not being correctly plugged or damage to the connectors.
There are two versions of LFI cards, the new version is labeled R1.5 or higher. The LED
behavior is different since the 1.5 versions. Consider the following points:
Previous to V1.5, the SRC LED was always on. From version R1.5, the SRC LED is only
on if the LFI is actually creating 40V. Therefore, it is only on in select powered frames (up
to three frames in a system) and is never on in an S-frame.
The CAN LED on the previous version of LFI is replaced with an L-frame indicator, which
is labeled LFRM. The LFRM LED is on, regardless of whether the machine is turned on or
not, if AC power is supplied to the L-Frame. This LED is on in the L-frame only.
On previous version LFI, the Ethernet LEDs were always on. When the Ethernet cable
was plugged in, the LEDs changed color. On the R1.5 version, the Ethernet LEDs are off
until plugged in. After it is plugged in, the right LED turns on solid, the link LED and the left
LED blink, and the activity LED blinks during data transfer.
Power supplies
For models L25, D25, L55, and D55, the library offers the TS4500 frame control assembly
power structure, which combines drive power, library power, and AC power cord capabilities.
Each of the Lx5 and Dx5 frames comes with two power supplies. Model Sx5 frames do not
have their own power supply. Instead, they share power with an Lx5 or Dx5 frame, as shown
in Figure 1-42.
Patch panel
The patch panel that houses the cable connections to connect hosts to the tape drive is in the
rear of the frame above the drives, as shown in Figure 1-43.
Display panel
The display panel on the base frame of the TS4500 tape library houses the library power and
pause buttons. It displays library and I/O status indicators, as shown in Figure 1-44.
Table 1-13 lists the indicators and buttons that are available on the display panel.
5 Power switch
10 Pause button
Expansion frames with optional installed I/O stations also have a display panel. However, the
panel on expansion frames does not include the library power button, as shown in
Figure 1-45.
Pause button
You pause the library by pressing the pause button on the display panel (number 10 on
Figure 1-44 on page 48) on the base frame of your TS4500 tape library. This pause button
causes the library to move the cartridge accessor to the base frame and pause operations for
30 seconds or while a frame door is open. The pause light next to the pause button stops
blinking, and it illuminates solid to indicate that the library is paused (number 11 on
Figure 1-44 on page 48).
Power on
Complete the following steps to power on the TS4500 tape library to begin the library
initialization sequence and bring the library to a ready state:
1. From the display panel on the base frame of the library, slide the plastic cover that protects
the power button up to expose the button (number 6 on Figure 1-44 on page 48).
2. Press the power button (number 5 on Figure 1-44 on page 48) and wait to see that the
green power indicator turns on and stays on.
The power button executes a power-on initialization sequence for about 2 minutes. During
that time, the menus on the TS4500 management GUI are not available for use. After the
power-on initialization sequence completes, the library performs an inventory of the tape
cartridges.
Power off
Complete the following steps to power off the TS4500 tape library after normal operation, but
not during an emergency:
1. Ensure that the host application removed cartridges from all drives and that the library is
varied offline from the host (if the host is attached).
2. Pause the library by pressing the pause button on the display panel (number 10 on
Figure 1-44 on page 48) on the base frame of your TS4500 tape library. This pause button
causes the library to move the cartridge accessor to the base frame and pause operations
for 30 seconds or while a frame door is open. The pause light next to the pause button
stops blinking, and it illuminates solid to indicate that the library is paused (number 11 on
Figure 1-44 on page 48).
The health status pod on the System page of the management GUI also shows when the
library is paused.
3. From the display panel on the base frame of the library, slide the plastic cover that protects
the power button up to expose the button (number 6 on Figure 1-44 on page 48).
4. Press the power button (number 5 on Figure 1-44 on page 48) and wait until the green
power indicator light turns off.
Note: Always pause the library before you power it off. If you power off the library before
you pause the library, the library might take longer to come online after the next power-on.
Access Recovery
The Access Recover button can be used to unlock the administrator password and can only
be done from the front panel.
When you press the Access Recovery button, you have 15 minutes to log into the library and
reset the administrator password with a temporary password. You must enter a new
administrator password when you log out and back in again.
Press the Access Recovery button (see Figure 1-44 on page 48) then, complete the following
steps:
1. Log into the GUI by using admin for the user name and password.
2. Click Access → Roles and then, highlight the admin role.
3. Click Actions → Reset Password.
This feature can be used to verify any media for the ability to read all of the data that is on the
selected media within a logical library. Media verification is set up to run automatically on a
set date.
You can set a recurring schedule for verification by days, months, or years. After you set up
media verification, you can verify a single medium before the set date, if required. For more
information, see “Media verification” on page 255.
Web camera
After the mounting hardware feature is installed by an IBM service support representative
(SSR), you can mount a web camera in any frame of a TS4500 tape library. Certain
clearances are necessary to accommodate the mounting hardware and the camera.
The camera is client-supplied and it can be installed in any frame to visually monitor the
location of the library’s robotics. Feature Code (FC) 1530, Web Camera Mounting Hardware,
is required to install a web camera. The maximum camera dimensions can vary. However, no
part of the camera can extend more than 60 mm (2.36 in.) from the center of the tripod mount
to ensure sufficient clearance so that the accessor movement is not obstructed.
The camera mount (FC 1530) can be mounted on the front or rear frame support.
Fire suppression
Each Dx5, Lx5, Sx5, and Sx4 frame in the TS4500 tape library has an area on the top where
an opening can be cut to allow the entrance of pipes, conduits, or other parts to use for fire
suppression. The installation of a fire-suppression system is the responsibility of the client.
The TS4500 tape library is constructed to allow the third-party installation of fire-suppression
equipment. When you are deciding whether to implement fire-suppression equipment, see
the local and national standards and regulations.
Important: For advice about selecting a fire-suppression system that provides the correct
level of coverage and protection, consult your insurance underwriter and local fire marshal
(or local building inspector). IBM designs and manufactures equipment to internal and
external standards that require certain environments for reliable operation. Because IBM
does not test any equipment for compatibility with fire-suppression systems, IBM does not
make compatibility claims of any kind nor does IBM provide suggestions about
fire-suppression systems.
A client-setup unit (CSU) is a feature that you, as the client, can install when the feature is
ordered as a field upgrade. If you choose not to install a CSU, IBM can install it for an extra
charge. However, detailed installation instructions are included when you order and receive
these features. Table 1-14 lists the available feature codes.
Table 1-14 Feature codes for the frame models of the TS4500 tape library
Feature Model CSU Description
code
1406 L25, L55 No TS1160, TS1155 and TS1150 tape drive support.
This triggers the shipment of a JL CE cartridge. When model L25 is ordered
or when FC 9080 (Mixed Media) is ordered for model L55 a minimum of one
of FC 1404 or 1406 is required but any can be selected.
1460 L25, L55 No Redundant Accessor Power/Network, which provides power and internal
network redundancy for the L25/L55 frame. This is a prerequisite to FC
9002.
1521 D25, D55, L25, L55 No First TS4500 quad drive mounting kit.
Prerequisite: FC 1450 (for Dx5 frame models only).
1522 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Second TS4500 quad drive mounting kit.
Prerequisite: FC 1521. This feature is not supported if the frame is used as
an integrated service bay (ISB).
1523 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Third TS4500 quad drive mounting kit.
Prerequisite: FC 1522. This feature is not supported if the frame is used as
an integrated service bay (ISB).
1524 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Fourth TS4500 quad drive mounting kit.
Prerequisite: FC 1523. This feature is not supported if the frame is used as
an integrated service bay (ISB).
1530 D25, D55, L25, L55, No Web camera mounting hardware. Provides mounting hardware only.
S25, S55
1604 L25, L55 Yes Transparent LTO encryption provides license keys to enable transparent LTO
encryption.
1628 L55 Yes Additional LTO Cartridge Magazines. Provides magazine and cover for
transport or storage of up to 18 cartridges.
1629 L25 Yes Additional 3592 Cartridge Magazine. Provides magazine and cover for
transport or storage of up to 16 cartridges.
1643 L25, L55 Yes Intermediate capacity on demand (CoD) provides a license key to increase
storage from entry capacity to intermediate capacity.
1644 L25, L55 Yes Base capacity on demand provides a license key to increase storage from
intermediate capacity to base capacity. This feature code is a prerequisite
for FC 9002 or Model Lx5 HD CoD FC 164x.
Prerequisite: FC 1643.
1652 D25, D55 No Two additional I/O stations. This feature code adds either 36 (LTO) or 32
(3592) I/O slots.
1663 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Drive removal. One 3592 tape drive install feature or one 3588 tape drive
install feature should be removed from the library frame when a tape drive is
removed.
1742 S24, S54 No TS4500 Control upgrade. This FC includes 1x top panel and 2x Ethernet
cables, card cages, ASCs, BPCs, and LFIs.
1750 TR1 No Left-side and right-side end covers. This feature is required only for the first
top rack that is ordered (if multiple top racks are installed on adjacent
frames).
1751 TR1 No Power distribution unit FC 1751 provides one PDU to be mounted in the top
rack. The first PDU in a top rack does not consume any of the 10U of rack
space. The second PDU in a top rack consumes 1U of rack space.
A maximum of two FC 1750s can be ordered.
Prerequisite: For each FC 1751 ordered, one power cord (FC 9954 through
FC 9959 or FC 9966) must also be ordered.
1909 L25, L55, D25, D55 No Single power source bifurcated cable. This feature allows attachment of a
powered frame to a single outlet while it also maintains drive redundant
power.
1951 D25, D55, L25, L55, No Power distribution units. This feature provides two PDUs, mounting
S25, S55 hardware, including rack brackets, and internal power cables.
FC 1951 supports any combination of up to three pairs of power cords for
FC 4875 on the same frame and FC 9989 on adjacent frames.
Corequisite: One power cord feature (FC 9954 through FC 9959 or FC
9966).
2071 L25, L55 No Flex track guide. This FC includes AXY, AXY plate, ASC to Flex track cable
and new end stops.
2072 D25, D55, S25, S55, No Flex track guide for expansion frame.
S24, S54
2309 D25, D55, L25, L55 No TS4500 Accessor Refresh. This FC provides complete accessor assembly
with HD grippers to Lxx models or models with FC 1442.
Prerequisite: FC 2071, FC 2072, or FC 9071, FC 9072.
2704 D25, D55, S25, S55, No Console expansion. 26-port Ethernet switch, rack mount. This feature
S24, S54 provides a 26-Port Ethernet switch and an attachment cable for connection
to a TS3000 System Console or Master Console for Service. Up to 24
additional connections are provided by this feature.
Mutually exclusive with FC 1951 and FC 4879.
2715 L25, L55 No TSSC Console attachment. This FC is a cable to attach a unit to the Ethernet
switch provided by the TSSC.
A maximum of 43 of the FC 2715 can be included in a single TSSC facility.
FC 2704 is supported on Lx5 models if you are connecting the frame to an
existing TSSC.
2735 L25, L55 No USB Optical Drive. This feature provides a USB optical drive for use with the
integrated management console (IMC). The optical drive is required for IMC
code and service Knowledge Center updates.
2737 S25, S55 No IMC Separate Power Source. This feature will allow longer distances
between the IMC end panel and an FCA by supplying 2x longer Ethernet
cables. For both plant and field, instructions will also be provided for moving
the IMC PDU from another frame into this frame. One of the FC 9970-9985,
9989 power cords is a prerequisite to FC 2737.
4879 L25, D25 Yes TS7700 BE Switch Mounting Hardware. This feature provides 2x Fibre
Channel switch mounting hardware, including rack brackets and power
cords.
The prerequisite is FC 4880. PDUs are not required with TS7700 back-end
switches in a TS4500.
4880 L25, D25 Yes TS7700 BE 16 Gb Switch. This feature provides one 16 Gb Fibre Channel
switch with 24 LC Shortwave ports. The 16 Gb switch supports attachment
of up to sixteen 3592 tape drives to a TS7700.
Because two switches are required by the TS7700 for redundancy, ensure
two are ordered for TS700 attachment.
Patch-panel-to-switch Fibre Channel cables are ordered against the frame
that contains the tape drives by using feature codes AGK1 (if tape drives are
2 or 3 frames away from the switch) or AGKQ (if tape drives are fewer than
2 frames away from the switch).
6013 D25, D55, L25, L55 Yes LC to LC Fibre Channel cable - 13 m (43 ft.).
6025 D25, D55, L25, L55 Yes LC to LC Fibre Channel cable - 25 m (82 ft.).
6061 D25, D55, L25, L55 Yes LC to LC Fibre Channel cable - 61 m (200 ft.).
8750 D55, L55 No LTO cleaning cartridge (FC 8750). This FC is a universal cleaning cartridge.
9002 L25, L55 No First expansion frame attachment. This feature is used as a part of the
process to add any Dxx or Sxx frame.
Prerequisites: FC 1460 and FC 1644.
9003 L25, L55 No Additional expansion frame attachment. This feature is used as a part of the
process to add any Dxx or Sxx frame.
Prerequisites: The first expansion frame attachment (FC 9002) is required.
9040 L25, L55 No High availability library. The prerequisite is FC 9071 or FC 2071, flex track A
cable FC 2002 or FC 2006 or FC 2014 or 2019, and flex track B cable
FC 2402 or FC 2406 or FC 2414 or FC 2418.
9071 L25, L55 No Flex Track Guide Base. This feature includes AXY, AXY plate, ASC to Flex
track cable and new end stops. The prerequisite is FC 2002 or FC 2006 or
FC 2014 or FC 2018.
9072 D25, D55, S25, S55, No Flex Track Guide for expansion frame.
S54, D54
9080 L25, L55 No Mixed Media Library. Library contains a mix of LTO and 3592 frames.
Prerequisite:
For Model L25, prerequisite of FC 1628 (LTO Magazine) and a minimum
of one of FC 1405 or FC 1407 (LTO CE cartridge).
For Model L55, prerequisite of FC 1629 (3592 Magazine) and FC 1404
(3592 CE cartridge).
Mixed media is not supported for Lx2/Lx3.
9213 L25, L55 No Attached to another system that is not an IBM system.
9690 D25, D55, L25, L55 No 3588/3592 drive. Field install. FC 9690 is a counting feature code.
Prerequisite: FC 152x (drive mounting kit). Each FC 152x supports up to four
of FC 969x.
9692 L25, L55 No 3592 E07/EH7 tape drive. Plant install. FC 9692 is a manufacturing routing
code. Prerequisite: FC 152x (drive mounting kit).
9695 L55, D55 No 3588 F5A/F5C tape drive. Plant install. FC 9695 is a manufacturing routing
code. Prerequisite: FC 152x (drive mounting kit).
9697 L55, D55 No 3588 F6A/F6C tape drive. Plant install. FC 9697 is a manufacturing routing
code. Prerequisite: FC 152x (drive mounting kit).
9700 D25, D55, L25, L55 No No host attach cables - from plant.
9704 L55, D25 No 3592 55E tape drive. Plant install. FC 9704 is a manufacturing routing code.
Prerequisite: FC 152x (drive mounting kit).
9705 L55, D25 No 3592 55F tape drive. Plant install. FC 9705 is a manufacturing routing code.
Prerequisite: FC 152x (drive mounting kit).
9735 L25, L55 No IMC broadband Call Home. This feature indicates that you allow broadband
Call Home, so no additional remote service tools are required.
9954 D25, D55, L25, L55, No NEMA L6-30 Power Cord. FC 9954 is used with PDU FCs 1751 or 1951. FC
S25, S55 9954 provides 1x power cord for FC 1751 and 2x power cords for FC 195x.
9955 D25, D55, L25, L55, No RS 3750DP power cord. FC 9955 is used with PDU FCs 1751 or 1951. FC
S25, S55 9955 provides 1x power cord for FC 1751 and 2x power cords for FC 195x.
9956 D25, D55, L25, L55, No IEC 309 power cord. FC 9956 is used with PDU FCs 1751 or 1951. FC 9956
S25, S55 provides 1x power cord for FC 1751 and 2x power cords for FC 195x.
9957 D25, D55, L25, L55, No 4.3 m power cord (Australia/NZ). FC 9957 is used with PDU FCs 1751 or
S25, S55 1951. FC 9957 provides 1x power cord for FC 1751 and 2x power cords for
FC 195x.
9958 D25, D55, L25, L55, No 4.3 m power cord (Korean). FC 9958 is used with PDU FCs 1751 or 1951.
S25, S55 FC 9958 provides 1x power cord for FC 1751 and 2x power cords for FC
195x.
9959 D25, D55, L25, L55, No Unterminated power cord. FC 9959 is used with PDU FCs 1751 or 1951. FC
S25, S55 9959 provides 1x power cord for FC 1751 and 2x power cords for FC 195x.
9966 D25, D55, L25, L55, No Unterminated power cords (China CCC cert). FC 9966 is used with PDU
S25, S55 FCs 1751 or 1951. FC 9966 provides 1x power cord for FC 1751 and 2x
power cords for FC 195x.
9970 D25, D55, L25, L55, No Dual 4.3 m power cord (international, 250 VAC 16A single phase, watertight
S25, S55 connector, IEC-309). FC 9970 includes model-dependent contents. For
countries other than the United States and Canada, the connector is rated
at 16A (plug type Hubbell HBL316P6W or equivalent) for connection to
Hubbell type HBL316R6W or equivalent receptacles.
In the United States and Canada, the connector is rated at 20A (plug type
Hubbell HBL320P6W) for connection to Hubbell type HBL320R6W or
equivalent receptacles. This power cord is the default power cord for all
countries other than those countries that are specified for FC 9972 and FCs
9976 through 9983. This power cord can be used for all countries, except the
following countries:
Argentina
Australia
Brazil
Canada
China
Japan
Korea
New Zealand
Philippines
South Africa
Taiwan
9972 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Dual 4.3 m power cords (250 VAC 15, non-watertight twist lock connector,
Nema L6-15P mates with L6-15R). FC 9972 includes model-dependent
contents. It is the default power cord for US, Canada, Japan, Korea,
Philippines, and Taiwan.
Corequisite: FC 9972 must be ordered with FC 1901.
Only 1 power cord is shipped for an S25 and S55 to be used in conjunction
with FC2737.
9976 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Dual 4.3 m power cords with 10 Amp/250 Vac, non-watertight IRAM 2073
plug. FC 9976 is for Argentina.
9977 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Dual 4.3 m power cords with 15 Amp/250 Vac with earth pin InMetro NBR
14136 plug. FC 9977 is for Brazil.
Only 1 power cord is shipped for an S25 and S55 to be used in conjunction
with FC2737.
9978 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Dual 4.3 m power cords with 10 Amp/250 Vac AZ/NZS 3112/2000 plug.
FC 9978 is for Australia and New Zealand.
Only 1 power cord is shipped for an S25 and S55 to be used in conjunction
with FC2737.
9979 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Dual 4.3 m power cords with 15 Amp/250 Vac JIS C8303, C8306 plug.
FC 9979 is for Japan.
Only 1 power cord is shipped for an S25 and S55 to be used in conjunction
with FC2737.
9980 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Dual 4.3 m power cords with 10 Amp/250 Vac, GB 2099.1, 1002 plug.
FC 9980 is for China.
Only 1 power cord is shipped for an S25 and S55 to be used in conjunction
with FC2737.
9981 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Dual 4.3 m power cords with 15 Amp/250 Vac with earth pin KS C8305,
K60884-1 plug. FC 9981 is for Korea.
Only 1 power cord is shipped for an S25 and S55 to be used in conjunction
with FC2737.
9982 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Dual 4.3 m power cords with 10 Amp/250 Vac CNS 10917-3 plug. FC 9982
is for Taiwan.
Only 1 power cord is shipped for an S25 and S55 to be used in conjunction
with FC2737.
9983 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Dual 4.3 m power cords with 10 Amp/250 Vac SANS 164-1 plug. FC 9983 is
for South Africa.
Only 1 power cord is shipped for an S25 and S55 to be used in conjunction
with FC2737.
9984 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Dual 4.3 m power cords with 15 Amp/250V single phase power cord
assemblies, NEMA L6-20P non-watertight twistlock 20A plug.
FC 9984 is 2x power cords, which are UL/CSA certified for use in US and
Canada. These power cords mate with client-supplied NEMA L6-20R
receptacles.
Only 1 power cord is shipped for an S25 and S55 to be used in conjunction
with FC2737.
9985 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Dual 4.3 m power cords with 15 Amp/250V single phase power cord
assemblies with watertight 15A Russellstoll plug.
FC 9985 is 2x power cords, which are UL/CSA certified for use in US and
Canada. These power cords mate with client-supplied Russellstoll 3743U2
or 9R23U2W receptacles.
Only 1 power cord is shipped for an S25 and S55 to be used in conjunction
with FC2737.
9989 D25, D55, L25, L55 No Dual 4.3 m power cords with 10Amp/250V with IEC 309 C14 plug.
FC 9989 is for use with adjacent frame PDUs (FC 1951) or external
(client-supplied) PDUs.
Only 1 power cord is shipped for an S25 and S55 to be used in conjunction
with FC2737.
AGKQ L25, D25 No 3-meter OM3 quad cables. This FC requires FC 1521 or FC 1522 or FC
1523 or FC 1524.
AGK1 D25, D55, L25, L55 No 10-meter OM3 fiber Cable (LC). This feature provides a 10-meter 50.0/125
micrometer fiber optic cable that is terminated with LC Duplex connectors.
AGK2 D25, D55, L25, L55 No 25-meter OM3 fiber Cable (LC). This feature provides a 25-meter 50.0/125
micrometer fiber optic cable that is terminated with LC Duplex connectors.
AGK3 D25, D55, L25, L55 No 80-meter OM3 fiber Cable (LC). This feature provides an 80-meter 50.0/125
micrometer fiber optic cable that is terminated with LC Duplex connectors.
For more information about ordering media, see Ordering additional LTO cartridges and
media supplies in the IBM TS4500 Introduction and Planning Guide, SC27-5990, which is
available at this web page:
http://www.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=ssg1S7005016
More than one platform-attached feature can be chosen because the library can be attached
to more than one of these platforms. Only one of each feature is added; that is, only one FC
9212 is required if two or more Windows servers use the TS4500.
Tip: The device driver is available for each operating system from the following IBM Fix
Central web page:
http://www.ibm.com/support/fixcentral/
1.6 Specifications
The TS4500 tape library is a stand-alone tape subsystem that consists of one or more
frames. It can expand in a modular manner to provide large capacities. The frames join
side-to-side, and they can be added on the left side or right side of the installed frames.
L25, L55, D25, D55, S25, S55, S24, 782 mm (30.8 in.) 1,212 mm (47.72 in.) 1,800 mm (70.9 in.)
and S54 (on casters)
L25, L55, D25, D55, S25, S55, S24, 782 mm (30.8 in.) 1,212 mm (47.72 in.) 2,320 mm (91.34 in.)
and S54 frames with top rack
L25, L55, D25, D55, S25, S55, S24, 782 mm (30.8 in.) 1,212 mm (47.72 in.) 1,800 mm (70.9 in.)
and S54 frame with covers
L25, L55, D25, D55, S25, S55, S24, 725 mm (28.5 in.) 1,212 mm (47.72 in.) 1,800 mm (70.9 in.)
and S54 frame without covers
a. Frame width only. Additional interframe spacing of 30 mm (1.2 in.) is required.
Table 1-16 lists the weights of the frames according to the number of installed drives, robotics,
and tape cartridges.
L25 Position 1 (leftmost frame) 407.8 kg (899 lb.) 586.5 kg (1,293 lb.)
D25 Position 1 (leftmost frame) 310.7 kg (685 lb.) 500 kg (1,103 lb.)
L55 Position 1 (leftmost frame) 410 kg (904 lb.) 592 kg (1,305 lb.)
D55 Position 1 (leftmost frame) 316 kg (697 lb.) 503.5 kg (1,110 lb.)
S25 Position 1 (leftmost frame) 299 kg (660 lb.) 491.2 kg (1,083 lb.)
S55 Position 1 (leftmost frame) 304 kg (670 lb.) 509.4 kg (1,123 lb.)
TR1 Weight of top rack (empty)c 24.5 kg (54 lb.) 24.5 kg (54 lb.)
Weights that are listed for the Lx5 frames include the accessor, IMC, side doors, and side panels. After the initial library
installation, these parts can be moved to other frames within the library string to shift part of the weight to other frames.
a. Frames in position 1 (the leftmost frame in a library string) can have a maximum of 12 tape drives.
b. Drive frames in positions 2+ can accommodate 16 tape drives.
c. A top rack can be installed optionally on any HD frame. Side panels and PDUs are also optional. Each side panel
adds 6.8 kg (15 lb.). Each PDU adds 4.5 kg (10 lb.).
When you plan for the installation, the space implications in the computer room must be
considered for the possibility of adding frames in the future.
The floor on which the library is installed must support the following weight specifications:
Up to 4.8 kilograms per square cm (68.6 lbs. per square inch) of point loads that are
exerted by the leveling jackscrews
Up to 211 kilograms per square meter (43.4 lbs. per square foot) of overall floor loading
The number of point loads that is exerted depends on the number of frames that makes up
the library. Four point loads are on each frame (at the corners of each frame).
For more information, see the IBM TS4500 Introduction and Planning Guide, SC27-5990.
Models Lx5 and Dx5 of the TS4500 tape library with installed PDUs (FC 1951) can power up
to two adjacent frames by specifying a power cord (FC 9989) on each of the adjacent frames
and plugging the cords into the spare outlets on the (FC 1951) PDUs, which are on the
adjacent Lx5 or Dx5 frame.
Figure 1-46 shows the first adjacent frame cord that is plugged into the PDU receptacles and
the second adjacent frame power cord that is plugged into the consecutive PDU receptacles.
The adjacent frames that receive power through FC 9989 can be up to three frames away
from the frame with FC 1951. By using adjacent frame power cords, clients can power up to
three frames from only two facility outlets.
Feature Codes
FC 1751 PDU 9 9 9 31
(for TR1 top rack)
FC 1951 PDU 17 17 17 58
TS1140f 0 28 50 171
TS1150f 0 23 48 164
TS1050f 0 16 32 109
TS1060f 0 13 36 123
TS1070f 0 15 31 106
TS1080f 0 18 40 136
a. To calculate the total cooling that is required by the library (in Btu per hr), multiply the total
power in watts by 3.41. To convert Btu per hr to kBtu per hr, divide your result by 1000.
b. Off refers to power consumed when the library is connected to an AC power source and the
library on/off switch is set to off.
c. Lx5 models and models with FC 1450 or FC1951 are equipped with dual AC power cords.
The figures in the table show the total power that is consumed, including power that is
consumed by redundant power supplies. Each power cord supplies approximately half of
the power.
d. Lx5 frame power includes all frame loads, cartridge accessor, IMC, and display.
For more updated information to calculate power consumption with drives, see IBM
Knowledge Center:
https://www.ibm.com/support/knowledgecenter/STQRQ9/com.ibm.storage.ts4500.doc/ts45
00_power_consumption_and_cooling_requirements.html
Table 1-18 lists the environmental specifications for the TS4500, which refers to the hardware
of the TS4500 tape library, and might lead to temperatures greater than allowable for the
cartridges and media stored in the library.
Table 1-18 Equipment environment specifications for the TS4500 tape library
Product operation Product power off
Data processing design criteria uses a preferred controlled environment of 22°C at 45%
relative humidity for the most reliable operation and performance. However, recommended
operating limits extend from 18°C - 27°C and 40% - 60% RH or 5.5°C DP-Dew Point - 15°C
DP. (ASHRAE 2016 TC9.9) Best performance is not obtained if the environment swings from
limit to limit.
For frames that contain LTO tape cartridges or IBM 3592 Enterprise Tape Cartridges, see
their environmental and shipping specifications for these products and adjust the operating
environment for the library accordingly:
https://www.ibm.com/support/knowledgecenter/en/STCMML8/com.ibm.storage.ts3500.doc/
ipg_3584_meesij.html
For more information about planning the installation of the TS4500, see the Planning topic of
IBM Knowledge Center:
https://www.ibm.com/support/knowledgecenter/STQRQ9/com.ibm.storage.ts4500.doc/ts45
00_planning.html
The high-density 2 (HD2) frames of the TS4500 tape library support HD2-compatible models
of IBM TS1160 (3592 60E and 3592 60F), TS1155 (3592 55E and 3592 55F), IBM TS1150
(3592 EH8), IBM TS1140 (3592 EH7), LTO-8 (3588 F8C), LTO-7 (3588 F7C), LTO-6 (3588
F6C), and LTO-5 (3588 F5C) tape drives.
The 3592 family was improved and expanded with the addition of IBM TS1160. The TS1160
is an enhancement over the fifth generation of the 3592 model EH8 and E55 tape drive family.
It provides unprecedented capacity of 20 TB of uncompressed data on a single tape and new
physical host connection options.
Note: This chapter describes only the 3592 models the attach to the TS4500. For other
3592 models, see the IBM Tape Library Guide for Open Systems, SG24-5946.
The 3592 tape drive family has the following common characteristics, which are described in
this section:
Technology enhancements
Reliability and availability
Performance or capacity scaling
Features that are designed for capacity and performance
Physical attachment
Media
3592 media cartridge
WORM functions
Tape encryption for TS1100
The tape layout consists of five servo bands (prerecorded on the tape) and four data bands
where the data is written, as shown in Figure 2-1. The servo bands provide location
information to control the positioning of the head as it writes and reads data within the data
band. For more information about this design, see “Servo tracks” on page 67.
As shown in Figure 2-1, the area between adjacent servo bands is a data band. The 3592
media has four data bands, each with a number of data tracks (128 - 288, which is different for
each model).
Data band 1
Data band 0
Servo tracks
Servo tracks or bands help to ensure accurate positioning of the tape drive head over the data
track so that the head does not stray onto an adjacent track. Servo tracks are necessary to
support high-data densities on the tape where the tracks are extremely close together. The
servo tracks are written at the time of cartridge manufacture before the cartridge is usable for
data storage and retrieval. Each tape write head has two servo heads, one servo head for
each of the two servo bands that it spans.
Two servo bands are used simultaneously to provide two sources of servo information for
increased accuracy. Control positions within the servo band are used to reposition the head to
write forward and reverse wraps within each of the four data bands. This timing-based servo
technology can be finely tuned. This technology supports extremely high-track densities for
future 3592 generations because more than eight positions can be defined within the same
servo band, which expands the potential track densities.
In addition, significant advances occurred in the tape coating process, which uses
high-quality metal particle media.
Improved availability
Improved availability includes the following characteristics:
Single field-replaceable unit (FRU)
When a service call is placed, the IBM service support representative (SSR) does not
replace any parts or subassemblies inside the canister. The new smaller drive unit means
that for any failure within the drive, the IBM SSR exchanges the entire unit rather than
performing lengthy diagnostics or component replacement in the field.
Redundant, hot-pluggable power supplies
In all configurations, the drives are seated in cradles that contain two power supplies.
Each pair of power supplies can be used by one or two drives. One power supply is
sufficient to run both drives, and the second power supply is provided for redundancy.
Retention of the Fibre Channel (FC) worldwide name ID during service action
When a failed drive is exchanged, you do not need to reconfigure the attached hosts or the
storage area network (SAN) to recognize a replacement drive. This function also
eliminates any issues with SAN hosts finding incorrect addresses during a system reboot.
Retention of the IP configuration for the Ethernet ports during service action
When a failed drive is exchanged, you do not need to reconfigure the attached Ethernet
hosts to recognize a replacement drive. Ethernet port configuration data is maintained
during replacement.
Advanced technology
Advanced technology includes the following characteristics:
Robust loader mechanism
The loader mechanism is suitable for the heavy-duty cycle usage in mainframe systems.
The leader block on the tape cartridge is replaced by a metal pin, which is enhanced over
previous drive implementations for increased robustness.
Elimination of drive pneumatics and mechanical adjustments
The aerodynamic movement of the tape over the flat-lap head pulls the tape close to the
head while the tape is moving, and provides maximum efficiency in reading and writing.
Because of the shape of the head, particles do not accumulate on the tape, which
eliminates the possibility of debris contamination of the tape surface. Air-bearing heads
effectively cushion the tape that is moving across the head.
However, whenever the tape stops, it relaxes toward the head surface. The head has a
two-stage actuator: one mechanism for moving to the required tape wrap, and another
finer actuator for adjustments to the track-following servo.
Straighter and shorter tape path for better tape tracking
Tape tracking is improved by using grooved rollers to provide surface-controlled guiding.
This enhancement decreases potential wear or damage on the edges of the tape and
decreases lateral movement with the shorter tape path.
Important: These features are generic for all 3592 tape drives. The TS1160, TS1155,
TS1150, and TS1140 offer other advanced features that are described in sections 2.2,
“IBM TS1160 tape drive” on page 84, 2.3, “IBM TS1155 and TS1150 tape drive” on
page 104, and 2.4, “IBM TS1140 tape drive (Model 3592 EH7)” on page 122.
Data buffer
The drive has a large data buffer with read-ahead buffer management that addresses the
lowest band of data rates. It effectively collects more blocks of data in the buffer before it
writes to the drive at a higher speed. As a result of this data buffer, the drive stops and
starts less often, which generally improves the overall performance and reliability of the drive
and tape.
Speed matching
For medium data rates, when the drive is operating from a host that cannot sustain the
maximum 3592 data rate, the drive performs dynamic speed matching. The drive adjusts the
native data rate of the drive as closely as possible to the net host data rate (after it factors out
data compressibility). The 3592 drive operates at various speeds (between six and 13
speeds, depending on the drive that is used) when the 3592 format is read or written to in an
attempt to match the effective host data rates.
If the net host data rate is between two of the speed matching native data rates, the drive
calculates at which of the two data rates to operate. Speed matching reduces the number of
required backhitches. In certain environments, the backhitch of the drive is masked by the
data buffer of the drive. Therefore, the system throughput is not improved or reduced by
speed matching.
Cartridge memory
The cartridge memory (CM), which is a passive, contactless silicon storage device that is
physically a part of the cartridge, is contained within the cartridge. The CM is used to hold
information about that specific cartridge, the media in the cartridge, and the data on the
media.
The 3592 uses the same CM module as LTO media, with a capacity of 4 KiB, which is
extended to 8 KiB on JB or JX media (and JC, JY, or JK media), and enhanced to 16 KiB for
JD or JZ media. The CM was designed for 3592 to support the high-resolution tape directory
feature. The CM differs from the LTO specification because it supports the high-resolution
tape directory feature. For more information, see “High-resolution tape directory” on page 70.
Communication between the drive and the CM occurs through a noncontact, passive radio
frequency interface (RFI), which eliminates the need for physical connections to the cartridge
for power or signals.
When the streaming writes cease, a typical pre-3592 tape drive halts the tape and repositions
it directly upstream of where the writing ended. From this action, data that is received later
can be written immediately after the previously written data. This method eliminates the waste
of the considerable length of tape. Substantial lengths of unwritten tape can significantly
reduce capacity. Here, a backhitch (reverse) by typical tape drives is used to eliminate this
loss of capacity loss after a write to tape.
Nonvolatile caching (NVC) is a 3592 feature that can help greatly improve write performance
through backhitch reduction. This system temporarily reserves portions of physical tape for
cache areas. Data that is received from the host is written to the volatile buffer as usual, and
to nonvolatile tape cache areas, with the exception that no backhitch is necessary when
temporary copies are written to cache areas of tape. This temporary capacity loss is easily
recouped.
The data is written to temporary cache areas and it is not released in the volatile buffer, but
instead it accumulates. This accumulation continues until the buffer is nearly full. At this time,
the accumulated data in the buffer is rewritten through a streamed write to the standard area
of tape.
When the rewrite is complete, the temporary cache areas of tape are released so that they
can be overwritten. To significantly improve the average write throughput to tape, temporary
copies can be written to the cache areas of tape without backhitching until the buffer is nearly
full. Then, a rewrite of the data can be streamed to the standard area of tape.
Aside from the improved write throughput performance, the second effect of NVC writing is to
recover the capacity that is lost by the standard writing technique. Data that is received
between synchronization events fills containers of data to be written to tape that are called
device blocks or data sets. The standard writing technique calls for padding the last partially
filled data set. This padding on average amounts to half the size of the last data set. With the
large data set sizes of modern tape drives, this loss can be substantial.
The streaming rewrite of the data that is accumulated in a buffer causes nearly all data sets
that are written to a standard area of tape to be written in full, which is known as data set
packing.
Writing in NVC mode is automatically started by the drive when host writing behaviors are
detected that can perform better when in NVC writing mode. Similarly, NVC writing is
discontinued when host commands are received that do not benefit from NVC writing, or
when commands, such as Rewind, are received. When NVC writing is exited, the drive writes
any packed data sets that are accumulated in its buffer before it runs the command that stops
NVC mode.
Because NVC writing is automatically started and stopped, it is not apparent to host
applications. The only indication that NVC writing occurs is the improved capacity and
performance that can result from this new mode of writing.
Note: The TS 1160 drive models supports capacity scaling only on the JE and JD
full-length R/W media. Capacity scaling is not supported for economy (JJ, JK, JL, and JM)
or Write Once Read Many (WORM) tapes (JW, JX, JY, JR, and JZ).
Although 256 settings of capacity are supported on the 3592 drive, the following settings are
often used:
Full capacity default mode
A 20% scaled fast access mode (capacity scaled, front of tape through an x'35' setting)
Performance scaling for 87% capacity (segmented format, capacity scaling setting x'E0')
Performance scaling, which is also known as capacity scaling, is a function through which
data can be contained in a specified fraction of the tape, which yields faster locate and read
times. This function is possible through the action of modifying internal formatting indicators in
the medium and in the cartridge memory chip.
The normal serpentine track format is altered in such a way as to limit the recorded portion of
the tape to a specified fraction of the length of the tape, as shown in Figure 2-2. In the 3592,
an application can issue a Mode Select command to scale an individual cartridge. It pertains
only to the cartridge that is loaded and it is not persistent.
Beginning of Tape
100%
Beginning of Tape
N ot used
20%
Figure 2-2 Examples for a 100% tape and scaled tape to 20%
The result of performance scaling a tape to a percentage value (for example, 20%) is that the
maximum number of recordable gigabytes is reduced to 20% of the normal value. Also, the
average time to locate a random record on a full tape that starts from load point is (roughly)
20% of the time to locate a random record from load point for a full, unscaled tape.
The cartridge can be rescaled from any current value to any supported new value. Tape is
logically erased by this rescaling. (The end of the data mark is written at the beginning of the
tape.) However, tape is not physically erased as with the long erase command.
When a scaling operation is requested on a JD type cartridge using the TS1155 drive, the
media will be up-formatted to the J5A logical format at the same time the scaling operation is
performed unless the format is controlled through explicit means.
Performance segmentation
Performance segmentation provides fast access and capacity by allowing the tape to be
divided into two segments. One segment is a fast access segment to be filled first, and the
other segment is more capacity to be filled after the first segment. Therefore, it is high
performance in two ways. It has segmentation and high-performance random access in the
first segment, as though it was a scaled cartridge, while it provides other larger capacity, as
shown in Figure 2-3.
The 3592 (model 55E and 60E model) tape drives are supported on open systems, servers
that are running Microsoft Windows only. Approval of i-RPQ 8B3685 is required to order a
TS1155 Tape Drive Model 55E and TS1160 Tape Drive Model 60E.
The 3592 8 Gb Fibre Channel (FC) attached tape drives can operate as a node loop port
(NL_port) (Fibre Channel Arbitrated Loop [FC-AL] support) or as a node (N_port) (supporting
direct connection to a SAN switch, which is also known as point-to-point or fabric mode). The
3592 tape drives autonegotiate to the N_port or NL_port, depending on whether a loop or a
point-to-point connection is detected when the drive boots.
The drives do not autonegotiate, if the drive was set to use a explicit setting of these
configurations. Regardless of whether the 3592 tape drives connect as an NL_port or an
N_port, they autonegotiate to be a public device (attached to a switch) or a private device
(attached to another N_port; that is, directly attached to a host).
The 3592 16 Gb Fibre Channel (FC) connected tape drives only operate in node or fabric
mode (N_port), supporting direct connection to a SAN switch or supported HBA. This is also
known as point-to-point or fabric mode. This port does not support FC-AL (Fibre Channel
Arbitrated Loop) mode.
If a library drive is replaced, an IBM SSR selects the replacement unit to automatically inherit
the configuration attributes of the failed unit. This way, a user can avoid reconfiguring the
zoning in the switches. Alternatively, the Management Interface (MI) can be used to change
these fields directly at any time.
For more information about FC attachment planning, see IBM TotalStorage Enterprise Tape
System 3592 Introduction and Planning Guide, GA32-0555.
For the latest information about applications and their levels that support 3592 tape drives,
see the ISV matrix, which is available to download as a PDF file from the “Independent
Software Vendor Matrix (ISV) for IBM TotalStorage 3592 tape drives and LTO topic at the
TS4500 product web page from the Resources tab:
http://www.ibm.com/systems/storage/tape/ts4500/index.html
The 3592 tape drives support industry-standard shortwave LC-Duplex fibre optic cables, with
cable lengths of up to 500 m (1,640 ft.) and 50 microns of core fibre, depending on the
required attachment speed.
The following maximum distances are supported by shortwave adapters with the 50/125
LC-Duplex fibre optic cables:
1 Gbps shortwave adapters have a maximum distance of 500 meters (1,640 feet)
2 Gbps shortwave adapters have a maximum distance of 300 meters (984 feet)
4 Gbps shortwave adapters have a maximum distance of 150 meters (492 feet)
8 Gbps shortwave adapters have a maximum distance of 50 meters (164 feet)
16 Gbps shortwave adapters have a maximum distance of 35 meters (115 feet)
Supported topologies
The 3592 tape drives support switched fabric and point-to-point loop topologies.
Switched fabric
Two or more FC endpoints connect through a switch. The FC architecture supports up to 256
ports through each switch. Switches include a function that is called zoning. By using this
function, you can partition the switch ports into port groups and then assign group access to
other groups. This function prevents group interference. With switched fabrics, all of their
ports have simultaneous use of the full FC architecture bandwidth.
Point-to-point loop
A point-to-point loop is similar to a point-to-point topology. Both have two connected FC
endpoints. The difference is in the protocol. Therefore, when only two FC endpoints are
connected, either protocol is usable. However, both endpoints must use the same protocol.
The 3592 model supports a point-to-point loop. Most FC adapters default to the loop protocol
when they are not directly connected to a fabric.
Important: SAN switches normally default the switch port to loop mode. If the port is set to
automatic mode, loop mode is the first mode that is attempted during the port login
process. The 3592 accepts loop mode and logs in to the port. To get the 3592 to login to
the SAN switch port in fabric mode, the port in the switch must be set to fixed fabric mode
by the switch administrator or in the drive by using the management interface. The TS1160
model 60F 16 Gb FC ports do not support FC-AL.
Address assignments
The 3592 tape drives must have an FC address to communicate over the FC interface. The
tape drives support hard and soft addressing. Most FC hosts (initiators) support hard
addressing and do not support soft addressing. For more information, see the device driver
documentation.
More information about SAN best practices and IBM SAN switches, see IBM Tape Library
Guide for Open Systems, SG24-5946.
Ethernet drives
IBM TS1155 Tape Drive, Model 55E, delivers 10 Gb, and the IBM TS1160 Tape Drive, Model
60E, delivers 10 Gb or 25 Gb Ethernet host attachment interface, which is optimized for
cloud-based and hyperscale environments.
The dual 10 Gb and dual 25 Gb ports uses shortwave multi-mode optical SFP transceivers
and the allowable cable lengths are listed in Table 2-1.
10 Gb 50 µm MMF LC 400 2 - 66
10 Gb 50 µm MMF LC 500 2 - 82
The TS1100 Ethernet drives currently supports iSCSI Extension for RDMA (iSER) on
Converged Ethernet (RoCEv2). This specific protocol utilizes a UDP transport layer and
required Data Center Bridging (DCB) switches and lossless networks.
Extensions for RDMA (iSER) is a standard that enables iSCSI hosts and targets to take
advantage of RDMA capabilities. iSER runs on top of a RDMA capable Network Interface
Card (rNIC) regardless of the protocol.
The TS1155 55E and TS1160 60E are supported by the Microsoft Windows device driver and
requires approval of i-RPQ 8B3685.
2.1.6 Media
Users must cost-effectively store more digital information than ever before, often to meet
growing regulatory and legal requirements. The 3592 tape drives help meet these needs with
IBM Tape Cartridge 3592. The TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, TS1140, TS1130, TS1120, and
3592-J1A all use the 3592 tape cartridge. This tape cartridge offers various capacity options,
depending on the drive and the recording format that is used or the cartridge model that was
ordered: Data, WORM, or Economy.
These capabilities expand the range of client data workloads that can be addressed with the
3592 tape drives. The economy cartridge can help lower the cartridge cost for users with
smaller capacity needs and provide faster access to data. The WORM cartridges provide
nonerasable, nonrewritable storage media. Users with regulatory or legal requirements to
store electronic records for long periods might be able to use the 3592 tape drives to provide
cost-effective storage.
The 3592 cartridges have a form factor that is similar to the 3590 tape cartridge. They are
supported in the following IBM cartridge library environments:
IBM TS3500 tape library
IBM TS4500 tape library
The tape features an ultra-smooth and uniform magnetic layer that is less than 0.2 microns
thick and a specially refined coating formulation that is designed to help improve media
reliability and performance and minimize the wear of the tape heads and components. A
precision timing-based servo with enhanced features helps enable high track densities, high
data rates, data access performance, high reliability, and stop-start performance.
The following media are used for the different media types:
Dual-coat, MP nanocubic particle, and Polyethylene naphthalate (PEN) substrate 8.9 µm
nominal thickness (JA types)
Dual-coat, MP nanocubic particle, and PEN substrate 6.6 µm nominal thickness (JB types)
Dual-coat, Barium Ferrite (BaFe) particle, PEN substrate, and 6.1 µm nominal thickness
(JC types)
Dual-coat, BaFe particle, Aramid substrate, and 5.0 µm nominal thickness (JD types)
Hc perpendicularly oriented BaFe particle (JE types)
Modifications to the cartridge design and construction help improve pin retention, hub and
clutch engagement, spool alignment, and tape stacking within the cartridge. These
enhancements help improve reliability and durability of the media and the tape drive.
Enhanced assembly strengthens the cartridge at critical locations and helps make the 3592
cartridge less susceptible to damage, such as damage from being dropped.
The tape is pulled from the cartridge with a leader pin rather than a leader block as in the
3590 cartridge. A sliding door covers the area that was formerly occupied by the leader block
in a 3590 cartridge. A locking mechanism prevents the media from unwinding when the
cartridge is not in a drive. A special mechanical design provision prevents the 3592 cartridge
types from being loaded into 3590 or 3490 drives. If a 3592 cartridge is inadvertently loaded
into a 3590, the cartridge present sensor does not change state and the drive does not
attempt to load.
Note: The TS1160 and TS1155 are not supported for z/OS attachment.
All 3592 tape drives support cartridge reuse. The 3592 tape cartridges can be reformatted to
any tape format that is supported by the tape drive when the tape is written from BOT. When
the tape is reformatted, all data on the cartridge is erased.
Note: Cartridge reuse depends on the compatibility of the media on the drive that is used.
By using their supported densities, 3592 tape drives can use different media. Table 2-3 lists
the capability of each drive to use media inside a TS4500.
Table 2-4 on page 79 lists the media types, native capacity options, and compatibility options
that are available with 3592 tape drives that are supported by the TS4500 tape library.
1 TB
(.9 TiB)
E06 format
Advanced JC 7 TB 7 TB 7 TB 4 TB
data (6.37 TiB) (6.37 TiB) (6.37 TiB) (3.6 TiB)
1 TB
(.9 TiB)
E06 format
Advanced JY 7 TB 7 TB 7 TB 4 TB
WORM (9.1 TiB) (6.37 TiB) (6.37 TiB) (3.6 TiB)
Important: The TS1160, TS1155, and TS1150 cannot read or write to JA, JW, JJ, JR, JB,
or JX media.
Media types JA, JW, JR, and JJ are not supported by the TS4500 tape library.
Labels
The 3592 cartridges use a media label to describe the cartridge type. Figure 2-5 shows a
3592 JE cartridge label. In tape libraries, the library vision system identifies the types of
cartridges during an inventory operation. The vision system reads a volume serial number
(VOLSER), which is on the label on the edge of the cartridge. The VOLSER contains 1 - 6
characters, which are left-aligned on the label. If fewer than 6 characters are used, spaces
are added. The media type is indicated by the seventh and eighth characters.
Cleaning cartridges
One cleaning cartridge is designed specifically for the 3592 tape drives. As with the data
cartridges, the 3592 cleaning cartridges are not interchangeable with any other model
cleaning cartridges (for example, LTO cleaning cartridges). Therefore, both types of cleaning
cartridges must be inserted into the library if both types of drives are in the environment.
The cleaning cartridge also contains a cartridge memory device, which automatically tracks
the number of times that it was used. Cleaning cartridges must be replaced after 50 cleaning
cycles.
The physical characteristics of the 3592 cleaning cartridge can be used to distinguish it from
the 3592 data cartridges. The product label on the top of the cartridge is white with the word
“cleaning” printed on it. Instead of the write-protect switch, a non-moveable light gray block
exists, which is shown as number 1 in Figure 2-6 on page 81.
Note: The IBM Enterprise Tape Cartridge is universal. It can be used on any model 3592
tape drive.
WORM basics
The 3592 tape drives support 3592 read/write cartridges and 3592 WORM cartridges. The
WORM cartridge is geometrically identical to a read/write cartridge. It uses the same
rewritable media formulation. However, the servo format, which is mastered onto the tape at
manufacturing, is different for WORM cartridge types.
The microcode of the drive does not support the overwrite or erasure of previously written
user data, such as records or file marks. However, the microcode of the drive supports
appending new data after the existing data.
This serial number is concatenated with the 8-byte unique tape serial number that was
created from information that was mastered into the timing-based servo at the time that the
cartridge was manufactured.
The parts of UCID that come from this combined serial number are written to a locked part of
the cartridge memory. This other level of security supports legal audit requirements.
Furthermore, the UCID supports unique cartridge tracking, and it can be the differentiator to
using other WORM tape providers.
The microcode tracks the last point that can be appended on the tape by using an
overwrite-protection pointer that is stored in the CM. The SARS data can be written and
updated on WORM tapes because the SARS data is not in the user area of the tape.
The 3592 tape drives allow append operations to data that is already on WORM cartridges,
and allow overwriting of file marks and other non-data attributes to provide application
transparency. However, they do not allow overwriting data under any circumstances. After
they are full of data, WORM cartridges cannot be reused or erased by the drive, and they
must be physically destroyed or bulk-degaussed to delete data. For full tape application use,
certain trailer and label record overwrites are allowed.
Important: Because WORM cartridges cannot be reused after they are written to, WORM
cartridges must be physically destroyed when they are no longer of use. If the WORM
cartridge has sensitive data, it must be bulk-erased before it is discarded. This process
erases everything on the tape, including the mastered servo pattern, which renders the
tape useless.
When an asymmetric or public/private key pair is generated, the public key is used for
encryption, and the private key is used for decryption.
TS1100 family of tape drives in the TS4500 use both types of encryption algorithm.
Symmetric encryption is used for high-speed encryption of user or host data. Asymmetric
encryption (which is slower) is used to protect the symmetric key that is used to encrypt the
data (key wrapping).
The TS1160, TS1155, and TS1150 support the capability to record encrypted and plain data
on a volume, under the following circumstances:
The drive must be in Application Managed Encryption (AME) (T10 method).
In the T10 mode, encryption is controlled on a block-by-block basis by the application.
New key associated data is stored within J6, J5A, and J5 format datasets as required to
support this feature. Labels are not recorded by using the zero-key method in this mode.
The reported Format Identifiers in Medium Sense reports non-encrypted J5A and J5
format identifier, unless all blocks on the medium are encrypted. Encryption format for a
volume is determined at first write from BOT, and is enforced for all subsequent appended
blocks. Labels are encrypted with zero key in this mode.
The TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140 tape drives support the following encryption
management techniques for open systems:
Application-managed encryption (AME)
Library-managed encryption (LME)
System-managed encryption (SME) (for z/OS supported drives only)
Note: System-managed encryption (SME) is supported in the TS4500 for TS1140, and
TS1150 drives only. This is provided for TS7700 IBM z Systems attachment only.
For more information about encryption, see Chapter 3, “Encryption” on page 173.
For more information about IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager, see the IBM Security Key
Lifecycle Manager V3.0 documentation in IBM Knowledge Center:
https://www.ibm.com/support/knowledgecenter/SSWPVP_3.0.0.1/com.ibm.sklm.doc/welcom
e.htm
Note: The TS1160 model EH9 or 60G drive is designed for installation in the TS3500.
Depending on interface type ordered, the TS1160 model 60E is available with dual 10 GB, or
dual 25 GB fibre Ethernet (RoCE v2) ports for host attachment. These ports are optimized for
cloud-based and large, open-compute environments.
The TS1160 model 60F tape drive has a dual-port, 16 Gbps Fibre Channel interface for Fibre
Channel attachment to host systems, or a switched fabric environment.
The TS1160 tape drive can read (read only), TS1140 formatted tapes on JC, JY, and JK
media.
The TS1160 can read and write to any media written in TS1150 and TS155 format.
Media written in TS1160 format is not readable by TS1155 or TS1150, but is back-portable for
reformatting of the media to TS1155 or TS1150 format.
The IBM TS1160 tape drive (which is also referred to as the 3592 Model 60F) is the sixth tape
drive generation of the IBM 3592 tape family. The TS1160 tape drive provides higher levels of
performance, reliability, and cartridge capacity than the TS1155 tape drive.
The TS1160 uses Tunnel Magneto Resistive TMR head technology, which is a
high-technology, 3-module, 32-channel head technology that is designed for higher native
data rate performance and reliability.
The TS1160 provide a native data rate performance of up to 400 MBps versus the 360 MBps
data rate of the TS1155 tape drive Model 55E.
The TS1160 records in the following native recording formats, which supports encryption and
nonencryption:
J6 logical format is used to represent the non-encrypted recording format for TS1160
J6-E is used to denote the encrypted recording format for TS1160
The TS1160 is downward read/write compatible to the TS1150 and TS1155 formats and is
read-only compatible to TS1140 format (J4 and J4-E) on supported cartridges.
Note: The TS1160 cannot read or write any format from J3, J3-E (TS1130), or earlier.
The host interfaces to open systems platforms are maintained as with previous 3592 models.
The TS1160 maintains the same features and technology enhancements that were
introduced with TS1120 and extended by TS1130, TS1140, TS1150, and TS1155. The
TS1160 offers several enhancements over the predecessor models.
When replacing a TS1160 model 3592 60E drive, the TS4500 maintains all iSCSI
configuration for the new drive by copying the iSCSI configuration to the new drive, such as
the IP address information and iSCSI names.
The port MAC address might change, depending on which level of LCC card is installed. In
the original version of LCC card, the MAC address might have to be changed manually by
using the CLI, if you want to maintain the same MAC address for each port.
With the latest level of LCC card, the MAC address is maintained the same as the replaced
drive, so no setting of MAC address is needed. This card overwrites the MAC address with a
TS4500-assigned address. This card is identified by the label on the LCC card (which is
shown as Version 4.X), as shown in Figure 2-9.
The TS1160 Model 60F offers a dual-port 16 Gbps Fibre Channel host attachment interface.
This feature provides flexibility in open systems environments, because drives can attach to
open systems servers directly with Fibre Channel attachments.
The TS1160 model 60E tape drive has a dual-ported 10 or 25 Gb optical Ethernet ports for
host attachment. This drive has been optimized for cloud-based and large, open-compute
environments
These drives have similar back panels, which is shown in Figure 2-10 on page 88 for the
TS1160 model 60F.
Figure 2-11 shows the rear panel of the TS1160 model 60E.
8 Port 0, 16 Gbps fibre connection Supports N_ports and NL ports only, direct
Fabric attach protocol
9 Port 1, 16 Gbps fibre connection Supports N_ports and NL_ports only, direct
Fabric attach protocol
The TS1160 have the same front bezel with a chevron fiducial as the TS1140. The buttons
and display are the same as all of the previous models of 3592 drives.
The drives have a standby cooling management feature, which reduces fan speed when the
drive is idle. It further reduces power and airborne debris contaminants. The fan operating
mode is controlled by a single input signal that is called full-speed mode or variable-speed
mode. In full-speed mode, the fan or blower runs at full speed. In variable-speed mode, the
blower adjusts its speed based on the ambient temperature down to a minimum of about 50%
of its full speed.
2.2.3 Media
The TS1160 drives use the new higher Hc perpendicularly oriented BaFe particle media
types.
This new media uses oriented perpendicular BaFe mag layer, which is an approximately
1.8 dB bbSNR improvement from JC/JD. The new media can be read/written up to 400 MBps
native sustained data rate (up to 900 MBps at 3:1 compression ratio) in the new 32-channel
Jag6, 6E, 5, 5E, 5A, and 5AE logical format, as listed in Table 2-6.
JE J6 J6-E
JM J6 J6-E
JV J6 J6-E
Important:TS1160 is not compatible with several older 3592 cartridge media types: JA,
JB, JW, JJ, JR, and JX media types J3, J2, and J1. (MEDIA5, MEDIA6, MEDIA7, MEDIA8,
MEDIA9, and MEDIA10).
The appropriate microcode levels that are available for TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and
TS1140 must be installed to enable the recognition of the J6 format and allow reuse of the
media in the older formats. Therefore, a model J6A drive can reformat media that was written
in the older format, and write on it in the appropriate format.
Important: This design supports a common scratch pool by media type regardless of the
last written format or allocation target drive.
For media to be reformatted on older versions of drives, the old drives must have the latest
FW version to support this process.
Capacity improvement
The use of the 3592-60E and 60F logical format offers the following capacity improvements
on existing and new cartridges:
IBM Enterprise Advanced Data media (JE and JV), which has a capacity of 20 TB
IBM Enterprise Advanced Data media (JD and JZ), which has a capacity of 15 TB
IBM Enterprise Advanced Data media (JC and JY), which has a capacity of 7 TB
IBM Enterprise Economy Data media (JM), which has a capacity of 5 TB
IBM Enterprise Economy Data media (JL), which has a capacity of 3 TB
IBM Enterprise Economy Data media (JK), which has a capacity of 900 GB
Performance
The overall performance is improved over the previous model by the following improvements:
Improved data rate and capacity
Improved latency by reducing access time to data
Increases HIB transfer rate to 1200 MBps
Beginning of partition (BOP) caching
Humidity sensor support
Increased cartridge memory size and related functions
Improved high-resolution tape directory (HRTD)
New dataflow ASIC chip in CU-32 technology
Extended copy support
Improved latency
These tape drives add the following features to improve latency by reducing access time to
data:
Improved locate and rewind speed profile for the new media types by using 12.4 meters
(13.5 yards) per second (m/s) end-to-end versus 12.4 m/s profiled (JE, JD, JV, JZ, JM and
JL media only):
– JE, JD, JZ, JM, and JL media feature a redesigned brake button for higher reliability,
longer life, and higher locate speeds.
– The improved profile represents a 9% speed improvement for a rewind/locate
operation from EOT to BOT versus the previous profile, which partially compensates
for the longer tape length of new media types.
Load and thread times are reduced by approximately 33% from 15 seconds load/ready to
10 seconds load/ready. This reduction applies to both JC, JD, and JE media types.
This improvement is possible by operating motors at a higher operating speed for repeatable
read (RR), loader, and threader motors.
Compression
The TS1160 drives feature the same history buffer usage in the compression core as
TS1155. The history buffer is 16 KiB, which enables more efficient compression by increasing
the history over which string matches can be applied. The new method increases the nominal
compression ratio for the Calgary Corpus data standard from approximately 2.0 to 2.5.
Note: The improved compression method is only available when processing the Jag-5/6
logical formats on the new JE/JV/JM media or upformatted JD/JZ/JL/JC/JY/JK media.
When processing the Jag-4 format, legacy compression method is used for compatibility
A key difference between SLDC and previous lossless compression algorithms is that record
boundaries and file marks are encoded as control symbols. The encoding of record
boundaries and file marks as control symbols allows the compressed data stream to be
separated into a serial stream of records and file marks by the decompression logic without
requiring additional information, such as information from an attached header.
This feature is automatic, cannot be disabled, and uses approximately 6 MB space (one data
set) in the main data buffer.
Humidity sensor
The drives contains a humidity sensor and a temperature sensor. The humidity sensor
provides the following functions:
Humidity tracing in drive logs
The drive logs humidity data in the tape map during read and write.
Maximum humidity logging in cartridge memory
The maximum humidity that is sensed during a cartridge mount is loaded in the cartridge
memory.
Humidity data is externalized in log pages and, as with temperature data, humidity data
can now be read through standardized SCSI Log pages by an initiator. However,
environmental thresholds cannot be set.
They maintain a tape directory structure with a high granularity of information about the
physical position of data blocks and file marks on the media. The longitudinal position (LPOS)
longitudinal location information that is contained in the servo pattern is associated with and
recorded with the host block information in the HRTD. This feature allows the 3592 to have
fast and consistent nominal and average access times for locate operations.
Therefore, locate times are uniform and based on the position of the block or file mark on the
tape independent of the uniformity of the block size or file mark distribution along the length of
the tape.
The 3592 drive has many redundancy and recovery features that prevent the possibility of
data loss in the loss of a directory. It also allows a rebuild of the directory under all
circumstances. consider the following points:
The HRTD table consists of information for each logical wrap. Each wrap area contains up
to 64 entries. Each entry contains the LPOS, logical block, and file mark count information
with access point and other internal information of interest.
The entire HRTD table is stored in the housekeeping data set on tape. The entire HRTD
structure is also written in the end-of-data (EOD) data set for the tape if the tape has a
valid EOD. The HRTD entries are also distributed in accumulating sequential fashion into
the Data Set Information Table of all user data sets as they are written on tape. Control
structures, which define the validity of the HRTD and EOD information on the tape, are in
the cartridge memory.
If a valid HRTD cannot be recovered from the housekeeping data set, the HRTD might be
rebuilt by using the EOD or distributed copies of HRTD information. The HRTD can also
be rebuilt by reading the tape. Depending on the mechanism that must be used to rebuild
the HRTD, this rebuild occurs quickly (seconds if the EOD copy can be used) or take
longer (minutes if a full rebuild is required).
The drive can read all data from a cartridge without any HRTD information, although
locate times might be affected. However, the drive does not allow a write operation without
a valid HRTD to guarantee the integrity and validity of the information on tape.
In default mode, SWBF mode (SkipSync) is entered after a flush is received under the
following conditions:
The received transaction size is greater than 204 MB compressed.
The drive is not already in Recursive Accumulating Backhitchless Flush (RABF) mode.
Enough excess capacity remains based on the current LPOS so that the drive predicts
that it will still achieve the minimum capacity threshold that is selected. The minimum
capacity threshold is 1.5% for the TS1160 default mode.
The following data rate ranges depend on the logical format and the media type that are used:
A total of 12 speeds of 122 MBps - 407 MBps for 3592 JE, JV, and JM cartridges that are
initialized in J6 format
A total of 12 speeds of 112 MBps - 365 MBps for 3592 JD, JZ, and JL cartridges that are
initialized in J5 and J5A format
A total of 12 speeds of 99 MBps - 303 MBps for 3592 JC, JY, or JK cartridges that are
initialized in J5 format
A total of 12 speeds of 62 MBps - 252 MBps for 3592 JC or JY cartridges that are
initialized in J4 format
Virtual backhitch
These drives include the following key feature improvements:
Virtual backhitch (transaction write with sync)
Single wrap backhitchless flush (large transaction writes with sync)
Backhitchless backspacing (American National Standards Institute (ANSI) file writes)
The TS1160 function utilizes Recursive Accumulating Backhitchless Flush (RABF) and the
addition of a new same wrap backhitchless flush (SWBF) function that extends virtual
backhitch effectiveness for large files.
Fast sync and skip performance for these tape drives are enhanced because of the better
data rate performance over the TS1140.
For more information about these features, see “Virtual backhitch (nonvolatile caching)” on
page 71.
With this unique function, the drive outperforms competitive drives, which stop and wait for
the next command.
Format support
The TS1160 drive models support capacity scaling only on the JE and JD full length R/W
media type.
EH7 scaled format behavior on JC media is unchanged from the TS1140, and full cartridge
accumulating backhitchless flush (ABF) capability is supported on any scaled cartridge.
When a scaled cartridge is up-formatted, the scaling value is retained, and the scaled
capacity is uplifted to the capacity ratio of the new format.
The effect of capacity scaling is to contain data in a specified fraction of the tape, which yields
faster locate and read times. Alternatively, economy tapes can be purchased.
Performance scaling limits the data that is written to the first 20% of the cartridge. When the
performance segmentation option is used, the overall capacity of the cartridge is limited to
86.6% of the total capacity.
The fast access segment occupies the first 20% of the cartridge, followed by the slower
access segment. Medium capacity is calculated as a fraction of nominal maximum capacity.
Scaled medium capacity is approximately equal to the nominal unscaled medium capacity
times this value divided by 256.
Segmentation is available only within a specified range of capacity scaling settings that
achieve this faster performance.
Tip: For more information about for the capacity scaling limitations and instructions for
setup, see IBM Tape Device Drivers Installation and User’s Guide, GC27-2130.
Unload time 36 s for JD, JZ, JL, JC, JY, and 36 s for JD, JZ, JL, JC, JY, and
JK JK
Maximum rewind time 94 s 100% scales JE, and JV 76 s 100% scaled JC and JY
34 s 20% scaled JE, and JV 26 s 20% scaled JC
76 s 100% scaled JC and JY 18 s JK
26 s 20% scaled JC 94 s 100% scaled JD and JZ
18 s JK 34 s 20% scaled JD and JZ
94 s 100% scaled JD and JZ 34 s JL
34 s 20% scaled JD and JZ
34 s JL
Interface burst transfer rate: 1600 MBps (FC-16) 800 MBps (FC-8)
Maximum
Number of tracks J6 format, 8704 JE, JV, and JM J5A format, 7680 JD
J6A format, 7680 JD J5 format, 5120 JD, JZ, and JL
J6 format, 5120 JD, JZ, and JL J5 format, 4608 JC, JK, and JY
J6 format, 4608 JC, JK, and JY
Number of passes (from BOT to J6 format, 272 JE, JV, and JM J5A format 249 JD
EOT) J6A format 240 JD J5 format 160 JD, JZ, and JL
J6 format 160 JD, JZ, and JL J5 format 144 JC, JK, and JY
J6 format 144 JC, JK, and JY
Linear density 555 kilobits per inch (Kbpi) 510 kilobits per inch (Kbpi)
Servo regions 5 5
Buffer size 2 GB 2 GB
2.2.6 Emulation
The TS1160 supports drive emulation, but not emulation mode.
Emulation mode
The TS1150 does not support any emulation modes. Because the drive cannot write the
TS1130, TS1120, or J1A logical format, it cannot fully emulate all format behaviors of a
previous model 3592 drive.
Drive emulation
The TS1160 tape drive does not support emulation. The TS1160 can read and write in J5A
and J5 format with compatible IBM 3592 tape cartridges.
The TS1160 tape drive can reformat any compatible J5 tape when it is writing from BOT and
the TS1160 can reformat any J5 format tape. Table 2-9 lists the available modes for TS1160,
TS1150, and TS155.
The TS1155 and TS1150 can reformat a compatible tape written in J6 format, but cannot
read in this format.
LTFS presents tape media as though it were a disk file system. IBM Spectrum Archive
supports the IBM LTO Ultrium 8, 7, 6, and 5, and IBM TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140
tape drives.
Tape as a storage medium offers many benefits. Tape is reliable, portable, low-cost,
low-power, and high-capacity. However, tape is not particularly easy to use. It has no standard
format, and data often cannot be used unless the data is copied to disk first.
With IBM Spectrum Archive and LTFS, accessing data that is stored on an IBM tape cartridge
became as intuitive as the use of a USB flash drive. With IBM Spectrum Archive, reading data
on a tape cartridge is as easy as dragging and dropping a file. Users can run any application
that is designed for disk files against tape data without concern that data is physically stored
on tape.
LTFS implements a true file system for tape. IBM Spectrum Archive also supports library
automation, including the ability to find data on a tape in a library without mounting and
searching tape volumes.
IBM Spectrum Archive Library Edition (LE) supports IBM tape automation and the single drive
edition IBM Linear Tape File System. With IBM Spectrum Archive LE, you can create a single
file system mount point for a logical library that is managed by a single instance of the
software, which is running on a single server. In addition, it provides for caching of tape
indexes, and for searching, querying, and displaying tapes’ contents within an IBM tape
library without the requirement to mount tape cartridges.
The TS1160 provides the same LTFS support as the TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140, but with
increased capacity and performance. LTFS is provided with the following features:
Ability to configure up to four partitions
Wrap-wise partitioning only
Support on all non-WORM media formats
Format command support
For more information about IBM Spectrum Archive and LTFS, see 2.10, “IBM Spectrum
Archive” on page 162.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 101
Important: If you choose this MES to replace the TS1140 drive, only the drive changes.
The canister remains the same. The serial number of the original drive is written by the
library to the vital product data (VPD) of the replacement drive. The MES is valid for both
the TS4500 tape library and a rack-mounted drive.
Important: You must load the IBM Assembly and Deploy Tools (IADT)-capable microcode
for a TS1140 drive before conversion to the EH8 model. Without it, communication to the
library is not possible. The IADT-capable microcode can be obtained from IBM Fix Central.
Only one MES model upgrade is supported in the life of the drive.
Unique LIC is required for the model 60E drives because the LOAD ID differs from the LOAD
ID that is required for previous versions of 3592. The firmware for the 3592 60E drive can be
updated by using one of the following methods, depending on where the drive is installed:
Through the TS4500 management GUI
Through the host attachment by using the write buffer command or IBM TotalStorage Tape
Diagnostic Tool (ITDT)
2.2.11 RAS
The RAS features are improved or maintained relative to the TS1160. They are similar to their
predecessor models (the TS1160 is a single FRU), which are hot-pluggable without a
maintenance window and support nondisruptive code loading. As with the TS1140, fan speed
management and unique device microcode file management are available through a LOAD
ID.
The end of life usage alert for media activates on full-file pass usage. The Nearing Media Life
alert occurs at 19,900 mounts or 295 full-file passes. The Media Life alert for JD or JL media
use within a TS1150 drive is now rated for 20 M motion meters as opposed to 300 Full-File
Passes (FFPs). The Media Life alert for JE, JM, or JV media that is used within a TS1160
drive is now rated for 100 Full-File Passes (FFPs).
The tape drive uses SARS to help isolate failures between media and hardware. SARS uses
the cartridge performance history, which is saved in the cartridge memory (CM) module, and
the drive performance history, which is kept in the drive flash electrically erasable
programmable read only memory (EEPROM), to determine the likely cause of failure. SARS
can cause the drive to request a cleaning tape to mark the media as degraded, and to
indicate that the hardware is degraded.
SARS information is reported through the TapeAlert flags and through media information
messages (MIMs) or service information messages (SIMs).
The 3592 drive maintains a history of the last 100 mounts for both Volume Statistical Analysis
and Reporting System (VSARS) and Hardware Statistical Analysis and Reporting System
(HSARS).
The TS1150 implements an enhanced SARS function that is known as client-centric SARS
(ccSARS). This function improves the overall amount of information that is maintained, and
the presentation means to the client in concert with the automation system.
The media SARS function for the drives includes the following actions:
Tape alerts are generated when media passes usage life, as determined by full-file
passes, meters of tape that were processed, or the write pass count, and the total number
of mounts (which was already supported).
A media SARS summary is maintained in the cartridge memory in a manner where it can
be rebuilt on tape if the SARS records on tape cannot be read and must be reinitialized.
This cartridge memory copy is also readable on an earlier level TS1140 drive to preserve
SARS information between logical format conversions.
2.2.13 Encryption
The TS1160 tape drives is encryption-capable. As with the previous models, you do not need
to enable the drive explicitly.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 103
2.3 IBM TS1155 and TS1150 tape drive
The IBM TS1155 tape drive (which is also referred to as the 3592 Model 55G, 55E or 55F) is
an enhanced fifth-generation tape drive of the IBM 3592 tape family. The TS1155 tape drive
provides higher levels of cartridge capacity than the TS1150 Model E08 (EH8). It is designed
to provide an increased capacity of 50% on JD media types compared with its predecessors.
Note: The TS1155 model 55G and TS1150 E08 are drives designed for installation in the
TS3500.
The primary difference of the TS1155 (55E, 55F) from the base TS1150 drive (EH8) is that
the capacity is increased on JD media types.
The TS1155 model 55E replaces the FC host attachment by dual 10 GB Ethernet (RoCE v2)
ports which is optimized for cloud-based and large, open-compute environments.
The TS1155 model 55F tape drive has a dual-port, 8 Gbps Fibre Channel interface for Fibre
Channel attachment to host systems, or a switched fabric environment.
The TS1155 Tape drive is capable of reading and writing 15 TB capacity on existing JD media
types (JD/JZ/JL) compared to 10 TB for TS1150. The TS1155 tape drive supports JC 4 TB
format (read-only) and JC 7 TB format (R/W). Media written in TS1155 format is not readable
by TS1150, but is back-portable for reformatting to TS1150 format of 10 TB.
The TS1155 Tape drive is not compatible with IBM TS7700 or Enterprise Tape Control Unit
environments.
The IBM TS1150 tape drive (which is also referred to as the 3592 Model EH8) is the fifth tape
drive generation of the IBM 3592 tape family. The TS1150 tape drive provides higher levels of
performance, reliability, and cartridge capacity than the TS1140 Model EH7 tape drive.
The TS1155 and TS1150 now utilize enhanced Tunnel Magneto Resistive (TMR) head
technology, initial generations of the TS1150 utilized Giant Magneto Resistive (GMR) head
technology. Both are high-technology, 3-module, 32-channel head technology designed for
higher native data rate performance.
The TS1155 and TS1150 provide a native data rate performance of up to 360 MBps versus
the 250 MBps data rate of the TS1140 tape drive Model EH7.
The TS1150 EH8 and TS1155 55F tape drives have dual-port 8-Gbps Fibre Channel
interface for Fibre Channel attachment to host systems, or a switched fabric environment.
The TS1155 and TS 1150 record in two native recording formats, supporting encryption and
nonencryption:
J5A logical format is used to represent the non-encrypted recording format for TS1155,
and J5A-E is used to denote the encrypted recording format for TS1155.
J5 logical format is used to represent the non-encrypted recording format for TS1150, and
J5-E is used to denote the encrypted recording format for TS1150.
The TS1155 is downward read-only compatible to TS1140 format (J4 and J4-E) on supported
cartridges, and the TS1150 is downward read/write compatible to the TS1140 formats.
Note: The TS1150 and TS1155 cannot read or write any format from J3, J3-E (TS1130),
or earlier.
The TS1155 and TS1150 support integration with the TS4500 tape library. Figure 2-13 shows
the IBM TS1150 (3592 EH8) tape drive and the TS 1155 (3592 55E and 55F) will be
physically the same format as the TS1150.
The TS1155 and TS1150 drive maintains the same features and technology enhancements
that were introduced with the TS1120 and extended by the TS1130 and the TS1140. In
addition, the TS1155 and TS1150 offers several enhancements over the predecessor
models, which are described next.
When replacing a TS1155 model 55E drive, the TS4500 will maintain all iSCSI configuration
for the new drive by copying the iSCSI configuration to the new drive, such as the IP address
information and iSCSI names.
The port MAC address might change depending on which level of LCC card is installed. On
the original version of LCC card, the MAC address might have to be changed manually by
using the CLI if you want to maintain the same MAC address of each port.
With the latest level of LCC card, the MAC address to be maintained as the same as the
replaced drive, so no setting of MAC address is needed. This card overwrites the MAC
address with a TS4500-assigned address. This card is identified by the label on the LCC
card, show as Version 4.4 or higher, as shown in Figure 2-14.
The TS1155 and TS1150 have the following key features, including those features that were
introduced with the 3592-J1A, 3592-E05, 3592-E06, and 3592-E07 (EH7):
Digital speed matching
Channel calibration
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 105
High-resolution tape directory
Recursive accumulating backhitch-less flush or nonvolatile caching (NVC)
Backhitch-less backspace
Virtual backhitch
Read ahead
Synchronous Data Link Control (SDLC) compression
Capacity scaling
Single FRU
Error detection and reporting
SARS
Revised encryption support
Dual-stage 32-head actuator
Offboard data string searching
Enhanced logic to report logical end of tape
Added partitioning support
Data Safe mode
Enhanced Ethernet support
New enhanced Barium Ferrite (BaFe) particle media types
Dual-port, 8 Gb FC attachment with failover support for FC drives
Dual port, 10 Gb Ethernet ports for TS1155 55E
Max Capacity mode logical end-of-tape (LEOT) support for up to 4% more capacity
Partitioning that is supported by Spectrum Archive and IBM LTFS
The TS1155 Model 55F and TS1150 Model EH8 offers a dual-port 8 Gbps Fibre Channel
host attachment interface. This feature provides flexibility in open systems environments,
because the drives can attach to open systems servers directly with Fibre Channel
attachments.
The TS155 model 55E tape drive has a dual-ported 10 Gb optical Ethernet ports for host
attachment. This drive has been optimized for cloud-based and large, open-compute
environments
These drives have similar back panels, which is shown in Figure 2-15 on page 107 for the
TS1155 model 55F and TS1150 model EH8.
Figure 2-16 shows the rear panel for the TS1150 and TS1155 model 55E.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 107
Table 2-10 describes all of the components on the rear panel and shows the normal status of
the light-emitting diodes (LEDs). The numbers in Table 2-10 relate to the numbers that are
shown in Figure 2-15 on page 107 and Figure 2-16 on page 107.
8 Port 0, 8 Gbps fiber connection Supports N_ports and NL ports, which can
autoconfigure between using the FC-AL
protocol and the Direct Fabric attach protocol
9 Port 1, 8 Gbps fiber connection Supports N_ports and NL_ports, which can
autoconfigure between using the FC-AL
protocol and the Direct Fabric attach protocol
The TS1155 and TS1150 have the same front bezel with a chevron fiducial as the TS1140.
The buttons and display are the same as all of the previous models of 3592 drives.
They have a standby cooling management feature, which reduces the fan speed when the
drive is idle to further reduce power and reduce airborne debris contaminants. The fan
operating mode is controlled by a single input signal that is called full-speed mode or
variable-speed mode. In full-speed mode, the fan or blower runs at full speed. In
variable-speed mode, the blower adjusts its speed based on the ambient temperature down
to a minimum of about 50% of its full speed.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 109
Internal hardware enhancements
These drives feature the following significant hardware enhancements over the previous
models:
Thirty-two channel-enhanced error correction code (ECC) recording format.
Enhanced JD-type media servo pattern.
Flangeless rollers, which are designed to minimize tape edge damage and debris buildup
by the elimination of the roller flanges.
Tunnel Magneto Resistive (TMR head) on the TS1155 and on new version of the TS1150
whereas older generation of TS1150 use a Giant Magneto Resistive Heads (GMR head).
These advanced heads are designed to reduce friction with advanced head coating to
prevent corrosion and to extend head and tape cartridge life.
Skew Actuator, which allows dynamic skew adjustment of the head to keep the head
perpendicular to the tape.
2.3.3 Media
The TS1155 and TS1150 drives use the following enhanced Barium Ferrite (BaFe)
second-generation particle media types. The new media can be read/written up to 360 MBps
native sustained data rate (up to 700 MBps at 3:1 compression ratio) in the new 32-channel
Jag 5, 5E, 5A, and 5AE logical format, as listed in Table 2-11.
Important: The TS1155 and TS1150 are not compatible with several older 3592 cartridge
media types: JA, JB, JW, JJ, JR, and JX media types J3, J2, and J1. (MEDIA5, MEDIA6,
MEDIA7, MEDIA8, MEDIA9, and MEDIA10).
These drives improve capacity and performance by writing and reading J5 and J5A logical
format and by using a new 32-channel enhanced ECC recording format with a higher track
density and higher linear density on the same media types.
Important: This design supports a common scratch pool by media type, regardless of the
last written format or allocation target drive.
Capacity improvement
The use of the 3592-55E and 55F logical format offers the following capacity improvements
on existing and new cartridges:
IBM Enterprise Advanced Data media (JZ and JD), which is a capacity of 15 TB
IBM Enterprise Advanced Data media (JC and JY), which is a capacity of 7 TB
IBM Enterprise Economy Data media (JZ), which is a capacity of 3 TB
IBM Enterprise Economy Data media (JK), which is a capacity of 900 GB
The use of the 3592-EH8 logical format offers the following capacity on existing and new
cartridges:
IBM Enterprise Advanced Data media (JZ and JD), which is a capacity of 10 TB
IBM Enterprise Advanced Data media (JC and JY), which is a capacity of 7 TB
IBM Enterprise Economy Data media (JZ), which is a capacity of 2 TB
IBM Enterprise Economy Data media (JK), which is a capacity of 900 GB
Performance improvement
The overall performance is increased over the previous model by various improvements:
Improved data rate and capacity
Improved latency by reducing access time to data
Improved data compression
Beginning of partition (BOP) caching
Humidity sensor support
Increased cartridge memory size and related functions
Improved high-resolution tape directory (HRTD)
Larger main data buffer
Extended copy support
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 111
Table 2-12 lists the capacity and performance characteristics for uncompressed data.
Improved latency
These tape drives adds features to improve latency by reducing access time to data:
Improved locate and rewind speed profile for the new media types by using 12.4 meters
(13.5 yards) per second (m/s) end-to-end versus 12.4 m/s profiled (JD, JZ, and JL media
only):
– JD, JZ, and JL media feature a redesigned brake button for higher reliability, longer life,
and higher locate speeds.
– The improved profile represents a 9% speed improvement for a rewind/locate
operation from EOT to BOT versus the previous profile, which partially compensates
for the longer tape length of the new media types.
Load and thread times are reduced by approximately 33% from 15 seconds load/ready to
10 seconds load/ready. This reduction applies to both JC and JD media types.
This improvement is possible by operating the motors at a higher operating speed for
repeatable read (RR), loader, and threader motors.
Note: For the TS1150, the improved compression method is only available when you
process the EH8 logical formats on the new JD, JZ, and JL media or on unformatted JC,
JY, or JK media. When you process the EH7 format, the historical compression method is
used for compatibility. TS1155 cannot write in EH7 format.
As in previous models, the 3592 tape drive uses the data compression that is known as
Streaming Lossless Data Compression Algorithm (SLDC). This compression method is
identical to the method that was used in previous models, except for the larger history buffer.
SLDC is an implementation of a Lempel-Ziv class 1 (LZ-1) data compression algorithm.
SLDC is an extension to the Adaptive Lossless Data Compression (ALDC) algorithm, which is
used in leading industry tape products. Users of SLDC can expect to achieve the same, or
better, data compression as users of ALDC.
This feature is automatic, cannot be disabled, and uses approximately 6 MB space (one data
set) in the main data buffer.
Humidity sensor
The drives contains a humidity sensor and a temperature sensor. The humidity sensor
provides the following functions:
Humidity tracing in drive logs
The drive logs humidity data in the tape map during read and write.
Maximum humidity logging in cartridge memory
The maximum humidity that is sensed during a cartridge mount is loaded in the cartridge
memory.
Humidity data is externalized in log pages and, like temperature data, humidity data can
now be read through standardized SCSI Log pages by an initiator. However, there is no
capability to set environmental thresholds.
They maintain a tape directory structure with a high granularity of information about the
physical position of data blocks and file marks on the media. The longitudinal position (LPOS)
longitudinal location information that is contained in the servo pattern is associated with and
recorded with the host block information in the HRTD. This feature allows the 3592 to have
fast and consistent nominal and average access times for locate operations.
Therefore, locate times are uniform and based on the position of the block or file mark on the
tape independently of the uniformity of the block size or file mark distribution along the length
of the tape.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 113
The HRTD feature maintains an overall granularity of 64 directory entries per logical wrap.
Consider the following points:
JA media 570 m (623.36 yards) logical wrap results in a granularity of 8.9 meters (29.1 ft.).
JB media 775 m (847.55 yards) logical wrap results in a granularity of 12.1 meters
(39.6 ft.).
JC media 842 m (920.8 yards) logical wrap results in a granularity of 13.2 meters (43.3 ft.).
JD media 1032m (1128.6 yards) logical wrap results in a granularity of 8.06 meters
(26.4 ft.). Granularity is improved for the segmented or scaled formats with shorter logical
wraps.
The 3592 drive has many redundancy and recovery features that prevent the possibility of
data loss in the loss of a directory and allow a rebuild of the directory under all circumstances.
Consider the following points:
The HRTD table consists of information for each logical wrap. Each wrap area contains up
to 64 entries. Each entry contains the LPOS, logical block, and file mark count information
with access point and other internal information of interest.
The entire HRTD table is stored in the housekeeping data set on tape. The entire HRTD
structure is also written in the end-of-data (EOD) data set for the tape if the tape has a
valid EOD. The HRTD entries are also distributed in accumulating sequential fashion into
the Data Set Information Table of all user data sets as they are written on tape. Control
structures, which define the validity of the HRTD and EOD information on the tape, are in
the cartridge memory.
If a valid HRTD cannot be recovered from the housekeeping data set, the HRTD might be
rebuilt by using the EOD or distributed copies of HRTD information. The HRTD can also
be rebuilt by reading the tape. Depending on the mechanism that must be used to rebuild
the HRTD, this rebuild can occur quickly (seconds if the EOD copy can be used) or take
longer (minutes if a full rebuild is required).
The drive can read all data from a cartridge without any HRTD information, although
locate times might be affected. However, the drive does not allow a write operation without
a valid HRTD to guarantee the integrity and validity of the information on tape.
In default mode, SWBF mode (SkipSync) is entered after a flush is received under these
conditions:
The received transaction size is greater than 204 MB compressed.
The drive is not already in Recursive Accumulating Backhitchless Flush (RABF) mode.
Enough excess capacity remains based on the current LPOS so that the drive predicts
that it will still achieve the minimum capacity threshold that is selected. The minimum
capacity threshold is 1.5% for the TS1150 default mode.
The following data rate ranges depend on the logical format and the media type that are used:
A total of 12 speeds of 112 MBps - 365 MBps for 3592 JD, JZ, and JL cartridges that are
initialized in J5 and J5A format
A total of 12 speeds of 99 MBps - 303 MBps for 3592 JC, JY, or JK cartridges that are
initialized in J5 format
A total of 12 speeds of 62 MBps - 252 MBps for 3592 JC or JY cartridges that are
initialized in J4 format
Throughput is increased through speed matching as the drive performs the following
functions:
Adjusts tape speed based on host data rate
Calculates effective host data rate (EHDR)
Optimizes data rate by selecting optimal EHDR
Forces speed changes mid-wrap if it is advantageous
Minimizes time to record data
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 115
Virtual backhitch
These drives include the following key feature improvements:
Virtual backhitch (transaction write with sync)
Single wrap backhitchless flush (large transaction writes with sync)
Backhitchless backspacing (American National Standards Institute (ANSI) file writes)
The TS1150 and TS1155 function is improved with Recursive Accumulating Backhitchless
Flush (RABF) and the addition of a new same wrap backhitchless flush (SWBF) function that
extends virtual backhitch effectiveness for large files.
Fast sync and skip performance for these tape drive are enhanced because of the better data
rate performance over the TS1140.
For more information about these features, see “Virtual backhitch (nonvolatile caching)” on
page 71.
With this unique function, the drive outperforms competitive drives, which stop and wait for
the next command.
Format support
The TS1155 drive models support capacity scaling only on the JD full length R/W media type.
The TS1150 drive writes the EH7 scaled format (JC media only) and the scaled EH8 format
(on JC and JD media). Segmented formats are supported.
EH7 scaled format behavior on JC media is unchanged from the TS1140, and full cartridge
accumulating backhitchless flush (ABF) capability is supported on any scaled cartridge.
When a scaled cartridge is up-formatted, the scaling value is retained, and the scaled
capacity is uplifted to the capacity ratio of the new format.
Partitioning support
The following partitioning is supported:
Scaling is supported only on single partition cartridges.
Issuing a Format Medium command to attempt to partition a scaled cartridge results in the
rejection of the command.
Scaling a partitioned cartridge results in resetting the cartridge to a scaled, single partition
format.
Performance scaling limits the data that is written to the first 20% of the cartridge. When the
performance segmentation option is used, the overall capacity of the cartridge is limited to
86.6% of the total capacity.
The fast access segment occupies the first 20% of the cartridge, followed by the slower
access segment. Medium capacity is calculated as a fraction of nominal maximum capacity.
Scaled medium capacity is approximately equal to the nominal unscaled medium capacity
times this value divided by 256.
Segmentation is available only within a specified range of capacity scaling settings that
achieve this faster performance.
Important: Capacity scaling is not supported for economy (JK and JL) or WORM tapes
(JY and JZ).
For more information about for the capacity scaling limitations and instructions for setup,
see IBM Tape Device Drivers Installation and User’s Guide, GC27-2130.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 117
2.3.5 Access performance specifications and drive characteristics
Table 2-13 lists the access performance and drive characteristics of the 3592-55E, 3592-55F,
3592-EH8 and 3592-EH7. For better performance, the block size of the data should be 256K
or greater.
Unload time 36 s for JD, JZ, JL, JC, JY, and 24 s for JB and JX
JK 36 s for JC, JY, and JK
Interface burst transfer rate: 800 MBps (FC-8) 800 MBps (FC-8)
Maximum
Linear density 510 kilo bits per inch (Kbpi) 500 Kbpi
Servo regions 5 5
Buffer size 2 GB 1 GB
Emulation mode
The TS1150 does not support any emulation modes. Because the drive cannot write the
TS1130, TS1120, or J1A logical format, it cannot fully emulate all format behaviors of a
previous model 3592 drive.
Drive emulation
The TS1155 and the TS1150 tape drive do not support emulation, The TS1155 can read and
write in J5A and J5 format with compatible IBM 3592 tape cartridges. The TS1150 can read
and write in J5 and J4 format with compatible IBM 3592 tape cartridges.
The TS1155 tape drive can reformat any compatible J5 tape when it is writing from BOT and
the TS1150 can reformat any J4 format tape. Table 2-14 lists the available modes for TS1150
and TS155.
55E and 55F J5A J5A J5A if format at J5A 55E or 55F
J5A format J5 J5 if format at J5
The TS1150 can reformat a tape written in J5A format, but cannot read in this format.
Tape as a storage medium offers many benefits. Tape is reliable, portable, low-cost,
low-power, and high-capacity. However, tape is not particularly easy to use. It has no standard
format, and data often cannot be used unless the data is copied to disk first.
With IBM Spectrum Archive and LTFS, accessing data that is stored on an IBM tape cartridge
became as intuitive as the use of a USB flash drive. With IBM Spectrum Archive, reading data
on a tape cartridge is as easy as dragging and dropping a file. Users can run any application
that is designed for disk files against tape data without concern that the data is physically
stored on tape.
LTFS implements a true file system for tape. IBM Spectrum Archive also supports library
automation, including the ability to find data on a tape in a library without mounting and
searching tape volumes.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 119
IBM Spectrum Archive Library Edition (LE) supports IBM tape automation and the single drive
edition IBM Linear Tape File System. With IBM Spectrum Archive LE, you can create a single
file system mount point for a logical library that is managed by a single instance of the
software, which is running on a single server. In addition, it provides for caching of tape
indexes, and for searching, querying, and displaying tapes’ contents within an IBM tape
library without the requirement to mount tape cartridges.
The TS1150 and TS1155 provides the same LTFS support as the TS1140, but with increased
capacity and performance. LTFS is provided with the following features:
Ability to configure up to four partitions
Wrap-wise and longitudinal-wise partitioning
Support on all non-WORM TS1140 formats (JC, JK, and JB formats)
Format command support
For more information about IBM Spectrum Archive and LTFS, see 2.10, “IBM Spectrum
Archive” on page 162.
Important: If you choose this MES to replace the TS1140 drive, only the drive changes.
The canister remains the same. The serial number of the original drive is written by the
library to the vital product data (VPD) of the replacement drive. The MES is valid for both
the TS4500 tape library and a rack-mounted drive.
Important: You must load the IBM Assembly and Deploy Tools (IADT)-capable microcode
for a TS1140 drive before the conversion to the EH8 model. Without it, communication to
the library is not possible. The IADT-capable microcode can be obtained from IBM Fix
Central. Only one MES model upgrade is supported in the life of the drive.
Unique LIC is required for the model EH7 drives because the LOAD ID differs from the LOAD
ID that is required for previous versions of 3592. The firmware for the 3592 55E, 55F, and
EH8 drives can be updated by using one of the following methods, depending on where the
drive is installed:
Through the TS4500 management GUI
Through the host attachment by using the write buffer command or IBM TotalStorage Tape
Diagnostic Tool (ITDT)
2.3.11 RAS
The RAS features are improved or maintained relative to the TS1140. Similar to their
predecessor models, the TS1155 and TS1150 are single FRU, which are hot-pluggable
without a maintenance window and support nondisruptive code loading. As with the TS1140,
fan speed management and unique device microcode file management are available through
a LOAD ID.
The end of life usage alert for media activates on full-file pass usage. The Nearing Media Life
alert occurs at 19,900 mounts or 295 full-file passes. The Media Life alert for JD or JL media
use within a TS1150 drive is now rated for 20 M motion meters as opposed to 300 Full-File
Passes (FFPs).
The tape drive uses SARS to help isolate failures between media and hardware. SARS uses
the cartridge performance history (which is saved in the cartridge memory (CM) module) and
the drive performance history (which is kept in the drive flash electrically erasable
programmable read only memory (EEPROM)) to determine the likely cause of failure. SARS
can cause the drive to request a cleaning tape to mark the media as degraded, and to
indicate that the hardware is degraded.
SARS information is reported through the TapeAlert flags and through media information
messages (MIMs) or service information messages (SIMs).
The 3592 drive maintains a history of the last 100 mounts for both Volume Statistical Analysis
and Reporting System (VSARS) and Hardware Statistical Analysis and Reporting System
(HSARS).
The TS1150 implements an enhanced SARS function that is known as client-centric SARS
(ccSARS). This function improves the overall amount of information that is maintained, and
the presentation means to the client in concert with the automation system.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 121
The media SARS function for the drives includes the following actions:
Tape alerts are generated when media passes usage life, as determined by full-file
passes, meters of tape that were processed, or the write pass count, and the total number
of mounts (which was already supported).
A media SARS summary is maintained in the cartridge memory in a manner where it can
be rebuilt on tape if the SARS records on tape cannot be read and must be reinitialized.
This cartridge memory copy is also readable on an earlier level TS1140 drive to preserve
SARS information between logical format conversions.
2.3.13 Encryption
The TS1155 and TS1150 tape drives are encryption-capable. Like the TS1140, you do not
need to enable the drive explicitly.
The TS1140 tape drive offers a dual-port Fibre Channel (FC) host attachment interface. This
feature provides flexibility in open systems environments because the drives can directly
attach to open systems servers with FC attachments. All TS1140 tape drives are
encryption-capable.
Currently, the IBM TS1140 tape drive (Model 3592 EH7) is the only HD2-compatible 3592
tape drive that is supported by the TS4500 HD2 frames.
Note: Drive Model 3592 E08 and E07 or earlier drives’ models are not supported by the
HD2 frames of the TS4500 tape library.
The 3592 tape drive communicates with the TS4500 tape library through an internal Ethernet
interface and uses Statistical Analysis and Reporting System (SARS) to isolate failures
between media and hardware.
The IBM TS1140 tape drive is the fourth tape drive generation of the IBM 3592 tape family,
and it is designed to provide higher levels of performance, reliability, and cartridge capacity
than the previous models of 3592 tape drives.
The TS1140 Model EH7 tape drive has a dual-port 8 Gbps Fibre Channel interface for Fibre
Channel attachment to host systems, or a switched fabric environment.
The TS1140 records in two recording formats, supporting both encryption and
non-encryption. Enterprise Format 4 (EFMT4) is used to represent the non-encrypted
recording format. Enterprise Encrypted Format 4 (EEFMT4) is used to denote the encrypted
recording format. With these recording formats, the noncompressed capacity of the extended
length MEDIA11 and MEDIA12 cartridges is increased from 1 TB to 4 TB.
Note: The 3592 JA, JW, and JJ (EMFMT1 and EMFMT2) media are not supported by the
TS4500 tape library.
The TS1140 supports integration into the IBM TS4500 library by using a new compact drive
sled. Figure 2-18 shows the IBM TS1140 tape drive sled.
The TS1140 has a new front bezel with a chevron fiducial. The buttons and display remain the
same as for all previous models of the 3592 drives.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 123
Figure 2-19 shows the front of the 3592 EH7 drive.
The TS1140 tape drive maintains the same features and technology enhancements that were
introduced with the TS1120 and extended by the TS1130. In addition, the TS1140 offers
several enhancements, which are explained in more detail on the following pages, over the
predecessor models.
The TS1140 offers the following key features, including those features that were introduced
with the 3592-J1A, 3592-E05, and 3592 E07:
Digital speed matching
Channel calibration
High-resolution tape directory
Recursive accumulating backhitchless flush or nonvolatile caching (NVC)
Backhitchless backspace
Streaming lossless data compression (SLDC) algorithm
Capacity scaling
Single field-replaceable unit (FRU)
Error detection and reporting
Statistical Analysis and Reporting System (SARS)
Revised encryption support
Dual-stage 32-head actuator
Offboard data string searching
Enhanced logic to report logical end of tape
Added partitioning support
End-to-end logical block protection support
Data safe mode
Enhanced Ethernet support
New enhanced Barium Ferrite (BaFe) particle media types
Eight Gbps Fibre Channel dual port interface
The TS1140 tape drive offers a dual-port 8 Gbps Fibre Channel host attachment interface.
This feature provides flexibility in open systems environments because the drives can directly
attach to open systems servers with Fibre Channel attachments.
The TS1140 Model EH7 has a new back panel, as shown in Figure 2-20.
Table 2-15 lists the components on the rear panel and the normal status of the light-emitting
diodes (LEDs). The numbers relate to the numbers that are shown in Figure 2-20.
8 Port 0, 8 Gbps fiber connection Supports N_ports and NL_ports, which can
autoconfigure between using the FC-AL
protocol and the Direct Fabric attach protocol
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 125
Number Description LED color or description
9 Port 1, 8 Gbps fiber connection Supports N_ports and NL_ports, which can
autoconfigure between using the FC-AL
protocol and the Direct Fabric attach protocol
Data cartridge
The TS1140 uses enhanced Barium Ferrite (BaFe) particle media types. The media can be
read/written up to 250 MBps native sustained data rate (up to 650 MBps at 3:1 compression)
in the 32-channel Generation-4 logical format. The following types of tape cartridges are
available:
IBM Enterprise Advanced Tape Cartridge (JC) - MEDIA11
IBM Enterprise Advanced WORM Tape Cartridge (JY) - MEDIA12
IBM Enterprise Advanced Economy Tape Cartridge (JK) - MEDIA13
The following TS1140 tape drive capacity and performance improvements are provided on
the existing 3592 media:
The TS1140 tape drive reuses certain TS1130 and TS1120 supported media types:
– IBM 3592 Extended Tape Cartridge (JB) - MEDIA9
– IBM 3592 Extended WORM Tape Cartridge (JX) - MEDIA10
Note: Media types JA, JW, and JJ are not supported by the TS4500 tape library.
The TS1140 improves capacity and performance by writing and reading the EH7 logical
format by using a new 32-channel enhanced error correction code (ECC) recording format
with a higher track density and higher linear density on the same media types.
Design feature: This design supports a common scratch pool by media type
regardless of the last written format or allocation target drive.
The 3592 tape drives can reuse different types of tape and multiple densities (logical formats)
across various drive generations. Enterprise format 4 (EFMT4) records 2,560 tracks on 32
channels. These logical formats can be divided into multiple subformat options, such as
segmentation and capacity scaling.
Capacity improvement
The use of the 3592 EH7 logical format offers native capacity improvement on existing
cartridges and new cartridges:
IBM Enterprise Extended data (JB) or WORM (JX) media, a 60% capacity uplift from 1 TB
to 1.6 TB (by using a 3:1 compression ratio 4.8 TB)
IBM Enterprise Advanced data (JC) or WORM (JY) media, a capacity of 4.0 TB (by using
a 3:1 compression ratio 12 TB)
Performance improvement
The overall performance is increased by various improvements:
Improved data rate
Larger 1 GB main data buffer
Better backhitching
Improved speed with digital speed matching
Enhanced read-ahead buffer management
High access performance for locate or search
Improved communication links with dual 8 Gbps Fibre Channel ports
SkipSync and FastSync write performance accelerators
New 32-channel enhanced ECC recording format
IBM Spectrum Archive and IBM LTFS Single Drive Edition, Library Edition, and Enterprise
Edition support
Note: Backhitching is the condition that occurs when a data cartridge stops, reverses, and
restarts motion. A backhitch is the result of a mismatch between the data rates of the
connected server and the tape drive.
Table 2-16 lists the capacity and performance characteristics for native data.
Buffer
The TS1140 EH7 tape drive has a 1 GB internal data buffer. In addition to enabling higher
performance characteristics, the data buffer is designed to support the “read-ahead”
capability of compressed data from tape. The data buffer provides high-performance random
skip forward sequential (short hop) locates, which are common in database search and tape
software recycle operations.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 127
This buffer improves the drive agility, file access, and small file handling. Furthermore, the
buffer reduces backhitches for all workloads and improves overall read/write performance.
Speed matching
The speed matching function is improved on the TS1140 tape drive because both the number
of speeds and the range of supported data rates are improved. The data rate range depends
on the logical format and the media type:
A total of 13 speeds, 76 MBps - 251 MBps for 3592 JC, JK, and JY cartridges that are
initialized in Generation 4 format
A total of 13 speeds, 74 MBps - 203 MBps for 3592 JB or JX cartridges that are initialized
in Generation 4 format
A total of 13 speeds, 41 MBps - 163 MBps for 3592 JB or JX cartridges that are initialized
in Generation 3 format
A total of 13 speeds, 39 MBps - 151 MBps for 3592 JB or JX cartridges that are initialized
in Generation 2 format
The TS1140 tape drive increases throughput through speed matching while the drive
performs the following functions:
Adjusts tape speed based on host data rate
Calculates effective host data rate (EHDR)
Optimizes data rate by selecting optimal EHDR
Forces speed changes mid-wrap if advantageous
Minimizes time to record data
The TS1140 function is improved with Recursive Accumulating Backhitchless Flush (RABF)
and the addition of a new same wrap backhitchless flush (SWBF) function that extends virtual
backhitch effectiveness for large files.
Read-ahead feature
On sequential reads, the tape drive automatically runs the read-ahead feature and fills the
buffer with data sequentially beyond the target block (N). If one of these blocks is a target of
the next command (such as N+200), it is already in the buffer. Therefore, transfer is fast. The
drive then automatically fills the buffer sequentially with data past N+200.
The 3592-EH7 supports read ahead of approximately 1,000 MB of compressed data from
tape. When the drive processes a command to locate or read a block, the drive automatically
continues to stream down the tape and to read ahead until the data buffer is full, which allows
subsequent Locate or Read commands to be fulfilled from the data buffer at faster speeds,
rather than requiring access to the tape. The drive outperforms competitive drives, which
simply stop and wait for the next command, with this unique functionality.
Performance scaling limits the data that is written to the first 20% of the cartridge. When you
use the performance segmentation option, the overall capacity of the cartridge is limited to
86.6% of the total capacity.
The fast access segment occupies the first 20% of the cartridge, which is followed by the
slower access segment. For example, with the Model EH7 tape drive operating in EFMT4
format, the 3592 Advanced Data Tape Cartridge (type JC) can be scaled to 800 GB. And, by
using performance segmentation, the 4,000 GB Extended Data cartridge can be segmented
into an 800 GB fast access segment and a 3,200 GB slower access segment. Segmentation
is only available within a specified range of capacity scaling settings to achieve this faster
performance.
Note: Capacity scaling is supported for economy (JK) or WORM tapes (JX, JY, and JR) in
read-only mode.
Check with the device driver user guide for capacity scaling limitations and instructions for
setup.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 129
Data safe mode
The 3592 EH7 supports data safe mode. Data safe mode is controlled by the application and
prevents inadvertent overwrite. Data safe mode treats the tape volume that is mounted as a
WORM drive and prevents inadvertent overwrite. Data safe mode is set by the application or
host system.
Servo regions 5
Buffer size 1 GB
The CRC is generated and checked at the tape drive end and the application end. The CRC
might be checked at any point along the path, at the host bus adapter (HBA), or at any system
or software that is in the middle.
On write, the CRC is appended to each logical block at the source and the CRC is checked at
any point that you want in the transfer. If corruption occurs, the exact location of the problem
is known. The logical block with the CRC is validated before it is committed to media. Data is
known to be on tape in uncorrupted form before the source data is released. The CRC is
stored with each logical block.
On read, the logical block with the CRC is read and validated. The CRC is transferred with
each logical block. The CRC is checked at any point that you want in the transfer, then the
CRC is validated and removed at the destination. Logical block protection uses the VERIFY
command as defined in the SCSI Stream Commands - 4 (SSC-4) standard, which adds new
options to perform the following functions:
Check that the protection information (that is, CRC) is the same protection information that
is configured.
Check the protection information (that is, CRC) and validate each logical block from the
current position for the number (n) of files (that is, file marks (FMKS)):
– No blocks are transferred over the SCSI interface.
– Happens at the native data rate.
Check that protection information (that is, CRC) validates on each logical block from the
current position to EOD:
– No blocks are transferred over the SCSI interface.
– Happens at the native data rate.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 131
2.4.4 IBM Spectrum Archive and LTFS support
The TS1140 provided LTFS support with the following features:
Ability to configure up to four partitions.
Wrap-wise and longitudinal-wise partitioning.
Supported on all non-WORM TS1140 formats (JC, JK, and JB formats).
Format command support.
Each partition can use a separate encryption method, or none.
Tape as a storage medium offers many benefits. Tape is reliable, portable, low-cost,
low-power, and high-capacity. However, tape is not particularly easy to use. It has no standard
format, and data often cannot be used without first copying the data to disk.
With IBM Spectrum Archive and the LTFS, accessing data that is stored on an IBM tape
cartridge became as intuitive as the use of a USB flash drive. With LTFS, reading data on a
tape cartridge is as easy as dragging and dropping. Users can run any application that is
designed for disk files against tape data without concern that the data is physically stored on
tape.
LTFS, which works with LTO-8, LTO-7, LTO-6, LTO-5, TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140 tape
drives, implements a true file system for tape. IBM Spectrum Archive also supports library
automation, including the ability to find data on a tape in a library without mounting and
searching tape volumes.
IBM Spectrum Archive Library Edition (LE) supports IBM tape automation, and the Single
Drive Edition is packaged with stand-alone drives. With IBM Spectrum Archive LE, you can
create a single file system mount point for a logical library that is managed by a single
instance of the software, which is running on a single server. In addition, it provides for
caching of tape indexes, and for searching, querying, and displaying tapes’ contents within an
IBM tape library without the requirement to mount tape cartridges.
For more information about IBM Spectrum Archive and LTFS, see 2.10, “IBM Spectrum
Archive” on page 162.
Important: IBM, Hewlett-Packard, and Quantum reserve the right to change the
information in this migration path without notice.
1
For more information, see “What is LTO Technology?” at http://www.lto.org/technology/what-is-lto-technology/.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 133
The LTO Ultrium compatibility investment protection is provided based on the following
principles:
Ultrium drive before LTO 7 are expected to read data from a cartridge in its own generation
and at least the two previous generations
Ultrium 8 drive expected to read data from its own generation and from the immediate
previous generation in the format of that generation
An Ultrium drive is expected to write data to a cartridge in its own generation and to a
cartridge from the immediate previous generation in the format of that generation
The three technology provider companies (IBM, HP, and Quantum) all made significant
contributions of time and expertise to the definition of the LTO format specifications. All three
companies have deep knowledge of clients’ needs. They provided expert knowledge and
engineering skill in the critical areas of magnetic recording technology, mechanism design,
media materials, and cartridge design. This cooperative process created stronger LTO format
definitions.
The LTO Ultrium 8 format records data on 6656 tracks across the ½-inch tape width. This
linear recording format has a serpentine characteristic. The drive mechanism makes multiple
passes from the beginning of the tape to the end of the tape and back to read or write the full
capacity of the cartridge
In the LTO Ultrium 8 format, the 6656 tracks are split into four data bands of 1664 tracks each,
and 32 read/write channels. Table 2-18 lists the values for the Ultrium 8 and previous LTO
generations.
Data is written to the innermost bands first to provide protection to the data that was recorded
earliest in the process by writing it in the center, which is the most physically stable area on
the tape. Data also is verified as it is written.
Because track densities (as shown in Table 2-18 on page 134) are high and because the tape
is subject to lateral movement as it is moved, for performance and data integrity, the
read/write heads must always be positioned precisely over the correct tracks. This positioning
is accomplished by using the timing-based servo technique. This technique makes it possible
to use high track densities (now and in the future) without changing the format of the media.
This technique allows data with media imperfections to be read.
In the LTO system, electronic signals are generated through the real-time reading of servo
data bands that are pre-recorded on the LTO tape. These signals enable the servo system to
dynamically control the positioning of the read/write heads across the width of the tape.
Similar magnetically based, track-following servo systems are used successfully in tens of
thousands of tape drives that are in use today, such as the IBM TS1100 tape drive (IBM
3592).
The LTO formats also use advanced error correction codes for data integrity. These systems
automatically correct most cross-track errors and provide data correction even if a full track is
lost. Data is further protected by the demarcation of bad areas of the tape (for example,
where servo signals are unreliable) and through dynamically rewriting bad blocks.
Cartridge memory is embedded in the LTO cartridges to record usage and error information.
A noncontacting radio frequency (RFI) module, with nonvolatile memory capacity of 16,320
bytes for Ultrium 8, 7 and 6, and 8192 bytes for Ultrium 5 and 4, provides storage and
retrieval.
Note: The TS4500 supports three LTO tape drives, the HD2-compatible models of the
LTO-8, LTO-7, LTO-6, and LTO-5.
Interleaved recording
The LTO drive uses an interleaved, serpentine, longitudinal recording format that is similar to
the method that is used in 3592 drives. The first set of 16 or 32 data tracks is written from
near the physical beginning of the tape to near the physical end of the tape. The head then
repositions to the next set of tracks for the return. This process continues until all tracks are
written and the tape is full.
The format of the recording of the data and servo tracks is defined as part of the LTO
specification to meet the requirement for interchange among implementations of different
manufacturers.
Servo tracks
Servo tracks or bands enable the accurate positioning of the tape drive head over the data
track, which ensures that the head does not stray onto an adjacent track. They are necessary
to support high-data densities on the tape where the tracks are extremely close together. The
servo bands are written when the cartridge is manufactured before the cartridge is usable for
data storage and retrieval. If the servo bands are erased, the tape becomes unusable.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 135
2.5.2 Data compression
The LTO Consortium created a superior data compression technique that is known as LTO
Data Compression (LTO-DC). Although an excellent data compression algorithm, adaptive
lossless data compression (ALDC) is not optimized for incompressible data, such as
encrypted or previously compressed data.
For incompressible data, it is best not to apply any data compression algorithm, but rather to
pass the input data directly to the compressed data stream (pass-through). ALDC might be
preferable, and at other times, a simple pass-through is better, because of the variations in
data. For example, if ALDC-based data compression is used, it is best if all segments of
incompressible data are recorded without expansion by using a pass-through technique.
Figure 2-22 shows the LTO-DC data compression technique that uses the two schemes.
Buffer
Pass-thru
Input Data
Logic
Selection
Compressed
Data Stream
ALDC
The ability to swap schemes between ALDC and a pass-through mode gives a tape drive the
power to automatically adapt to the incoming data stream.
No standardization of when to swap modes (scheme swap) when data is compressed was
specified by LTO-DC. LTO-DC was approved by Ecma International as the Streaming
Lossless Data Compression (SLDC) standard. For more information, see the Standard
ECMA-321 Streaming Lossless Data Compression Algorithm - (SLDC) page on the Ecma
International website:
http://www.ecma-international.org/publications/standards/ECMA-321.htm
Compression technique: LTO uses the SLDC technique for compression. The IBM 3592
tape drive also uses the SLDC compression technique.
Data cartridge
The Ultrium tape format specification is the implementation of LTO that is optimized for high
capacity and performance with outstanding reliability, in a stand-alone or automated
environment. The Ultrium cartridge uses a larger single-reel design (see Figure 2-23) and
½-inch tape to provide ultra-high storage capacity. The tape is extracted from the cartridge by
the tape drive through a leader pin and is wound onto a take-up reel that is contained within
the drive. This design is focused on client requirements for high capacity and performance
and is ideally suited for backup, restore, and archive applications.
Ultrium drive technology is intended to meet the needs of the enterprise on a roadmap, or
migration path, that extends well into the future. The Ultrium tape format established a new
benchmark for large volume backup and archive options.
An LTO-7 data cartridge and a WORM tape cartridge are shown in Figure 2-23.
In addition to standard read/write data cartridges, WORM cartridges are available. IBM
WORM data cartridges are two tones to distinguish them from other data cartridges. Each
WORM cartridge is the same color as the same generation of data cartridge on the top, but it
is gray on the bottom. All generations of cartridges contain ½-inch, dual-coat, metal-particle
tape. The three types of cartridges feature the following capacities:
LTO-8 and LTO-8 WORM tape cartridges have a native data capacity of 12 TB
(10.91 TiB) (30 TB [28.61 TiB] at 2.5:1 compression).
LTO-7 media formatted to M8 format, have a native data capacity of 9 TB
(8.185 TiB) (22.5 TB [20.954 TiB] at 2.5:1 compression).
LTO-7 and LTO-7 WORM tape cartridges have a native data capacity of 6 TB
(5.46 TiB) (15 TB [13.64 TiB] at 2.5:1 compression).
LTO-6 and LTO-6 WORM tape cartridges have a native data capacity of 2.5 TB
(2.273 TiB) (6.25 TB [5.68 TiB] at 2.5:1 compression).
LTO-5 and LTO-5 WORM tape cartridges have a native data capacity of 1.5 TB (1.364 TiB)
(3 TB [2.73 TiB] at 2:1 compression).
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 137
The IBM WORM cartridges are two-tone cartridges with a platinum bottom. The top is like the
normal LTO Ultrium cartridges.
The format specification for WORM for LTO Ultrium generations includes low-level encoding
in the cartridge memory, and the encoding is mastered into the servo pattern as part of the
manufacturing process. This encoding prevents tampering.
Data can be appended at the end of a WORM cartridge to which data was previously written,
which allows the full use of the high-capacity tape media.
Note: Client-printed bar code labels are not recommended for use on the TS4500. Certain
bar code labels that were previously successfully scanned by the TS3500 are not readable
by the TS4500. Issues with reading media labels are most often issues with those labels
that were printed by the client.
When read by the library’s bar code reader, the bar code identifies the cartridge’s VOLSER to
the tape library. The bar code also tells the library whether the cartridge is a data, cleaning, or
diagnostic cartridge.
In addition, the bar code includes the two-character media-type identifier Lx, where x equals
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, T, U, V, W, X. or Y identifies the cartridge as an LTO cartridge. M8 media
type denoted a LTO 7 cartridge formatted for LTO 8 use only. The possible values for the
second character are described in the following list:
1 indicates that the cartridge is the first generation of its type.
2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, M8, or 8 indicates that the cartridge is the second, third, fourth, fifth, sixth,
seventh or eighth generation of its type
T indicates that the cartridge is a generation 3 WORM cartridge
U indicates that the cartridge is a generation 4 WORM cartridge
V indicates that the cartridge is a generation 5 WORM cartridge
W indicates that the cartridge is a generation 6 WORM cartridge
X indicates that the cartridge is a generation 7 WORM cartridge
Y indicates that the cartridge is a generation 8 WORM cartridge
Apply the following guidelines whenever you use LTO bar code labels:
Use only bar code labels that are approved by IBM.
Do not reuse a label or reapply a used label over an existing label.
Before you apply a new label, remove the old label by slowly pulling it at a right angle to
the cartridge case.
Use peel-clean bar code labels that do not leave a residue after they are removed. If glue
residue is on the cartridge, remove it by gently rubbing it with your finger. Do not use a
sharp object, water, or a chemical to clean the label area.
Examine the label before you apply it to the cartridge. Do not use the label if voids or
smears are in the printed characters or bar code. An application’s inventory operation
takes much longer if the bar code label is not readable.
Remove the label from the label sheet carefully. Do not stretch the label or cause the
edges to curl.
Position the label within the recessed bar code label area.
With light finger pressure, smooth the label so that no wrinkles or bubbles exist on its
surface.
Verify that the label is smooth and parallel, and it has no roll-up or roll-over. The label must
be flat to within 0.5 mm (0.02 in.) over the length of the label and have no folds, missing
pieces, or smudges.
Do not place other machine-readable labels on other surfaces of the cartridge. They might
interfere with the ability of the bar code reader to read the bar code.
Bar code label specifications are listed on the IBM LTO Ultrium Cartridge Label Specification
web page:
http://www.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=ssg1S7000429
Cleaning cartridges
The IBM LTO Ultrium Cleaning Cartridge (which is known as the universal cleaning
cartridge) and the LTO Ultrium Cleaning Cartridge are compatible with all LTO tape drives.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 139
The cleaning cartridge also contains a cartridge memory device, which automatically tracks
the number of times that it was used. Cleaning cartridges must be replaced after 50 cleaning
cycles. The firmware in the drive detects whether a cleaning tape is expired.
The volume serial (VOLSER) number on the cleaning cartridge’s bar code label must begin
with CLNI or CLNU, or the library treats the cleaning cartridge as a data cartridge during an
inventory.
Note: The average number of mounts that a cleaning cartridge is mounted before it is
marked for replacement is 50. Because the count for cleaning is based on the tape length
that is used during the cleaning, this number can be more or fewer than 50 mounts.
Cartridge memory
Within the cartridge is the LTO Cartridge Memory (LTO-CM), which is a passive, contactless
silicon storage device that is physically a part of the cartridge. The memory chip is also known
as medium auxiliary memory (MAM). For more information, see the IBM TotalStorage LTO
Ultrium Tape Drive SCSI Reference (LTO-5 through LTO-7), GA32-0928:
http://www.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=ssg1S7003556
Information about the cartridge and tape is written to the LTO-CM. The LTO-CM is only
accessible and used by the drive itself and contains no client data. The LTO-CM is serial
Electronically Erasable Programmable Read-Only Memory (EEPROM) with read-only and
rewritable areas. It is housed inside the cartridge casing at the left rear (label side) corner.
The LTO-CM is used to hold usage and error information about the cartridge, the media inside
that cartridge, and the data on the media. The storage capacity of the Generation 8, 7, and 6
LTO-CM is 16,320 bytes, double the 8,160-byte capacity of the Generation 5 and 4 LTO-CM.
The Generation 1, 2, and 3 cartridges use a 4,096-byte LTO-CM. The LTO-CM is in the left
rear corner of the cartridge. A copy of this information also is kept in the first data set within
the user data area, and it is given the data set number zero.
Communication between the drive and the LTO-CM is performed by a low-level radio
frequency (RF) field that is generated (in the IBM implementation) by the drive. The LTO-CM
is nonvolatile storage that is updated by using the RF field. It requires no other power source.
This type of technology has an expected shelf life of more than 30 years.
Although transparent to the user, keeping this type of information enhances the efficiency of
the drive and the cartridge. Data and block locations are stored in memory. For example, the
end-of-data location is stored so that when the tape is next loaded, the drive can use the fast
locate function to move directly to the recording area and begin recording.
Storing data about the age of the cartridge, the number of times that it was loaded, and the
number of errors that it accumulated helps determine the reliability of the cartridge. This data
is of particular value if it is stored with the cartridge itself, so that whenever the cartridge is
mounted on any host system, the history is accessible.
This product is not the first tape product where information was kept on the cartridge.
However, previously it was written on the tape medium itself in a portion of the tape (that
users were not allowed to access) before the beginning-of-tape marker, such as in the IBM
3590 tape drive.
The Ultrium 8 tape drive is a high-performance, high-capacity tape drive. The drive records
data by using a linear serpentine recording format on half-inch tape that is housed within a
cartridge. The data tracks are located by using preformatted servo tracks.
The Ultrium 8 tape drive provides the following improvements over the older Ultrium 7 models:
The Ultrium 8 tape drive increases the native transfer speed to 360 MBps compared with
300 MBps for the Ultrium 7 tape drive.
The Ultrium 7 tape drive compressed speed of 700 MBps for Fibre Channel interface
The Ultrium 8 tape drive more than doubles the potential capacity of a cartridge in Ultrium
7 format
The LTO Ultrium 8 supports integration in the IBM TS4500 library by using a new compact
drive sled.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 141
The TS4500 LTO drive sled is shown in Figure 2-25.
The LTO Ultrium 8 Model F8C drive has a front bezel with a chevron fiducial. The buttons and
display remain the same as for all previous models of LTO tape drives. Figure 2-26 shows the
front of the LTO-8 (3588 F8C) tape drive.
Table 2-19 lists all of the components on the rear panel and shows the normal status of the
LEDs. The numbers in Table 2-19 refer to the numbers that are shown in Figure 2-27.
8 Port 0, 8 Gbps fiber connection Supports N_ports and NL_ports, which can
autoconfigure between using the FC-AL
protocol and the Direct Fabric attach protocol
9 Port 1, 8 Gbps fiber connection Supports N_ports and NL_ports, which can
autoconfigure between using the FC-AL
protocol and the Direct Fabric attach protocol
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 143
Compatibility
Ultrium 8 drives can only read and write on Ultrium 8 and Ultrium 7 cartridges, it cannot read
Ultrium 6 cartridges. Ultrium 8 drives can additionally read and write on Ultrium 7 cartridges
at 9 TB capacity. For more information about M8 format, see “M8 format media” on page 144.
The drive also writes to tapes that can be read by other licensed LTO Ultrium 7 drives. In
addition to using the IBM LTO Ultrium 7 data cartridge, with up to 6 TB capacity, the drive
offers read/write capability for certified LTO Ultrium 7 tape cartridges.
Note: The LTO-8 tape drive can only read or write to LTO8 and LTO7 format cartridges.
Table 2-20 lists the native data transfer rate when a data cartridge of another generation is
processed.
Native Capacity 12TB (11.176 TiB) 9TB (7.450 TiB) 6TB (5.587 TiB)
2.5:1 compression capacity 30TB (28.61 TiB) 22.5TB (20.954 TiB) 15TB (13.64 TiB)
M8 format media
The LTO Program introduced a new capability with LTO-8 tape drives. The LTO-8 drives can
write 9 TB (native) on a brand new LTO Ultrium 7 cartridge instead of 6 TB (native) as
specified by the LTO 7 format. Such a cartridge is called an LTO 7 initialized LTO 8 Type M
cartridge. These LTO 8 Type M cartridges are identifiable by using an automation barcode
label ending with the last two characters M8.
Only new, unused LTO Ultrium 7 cartridges can be initialized as M8 cartridges. After a
cartridge is initialized as M8, it cannot be changed back to L7. Initialized M8 cartridges can
only be written and read in an LTO 8 tape drive. LTO7 tape drives cannot read initialized M8
cartridges.
A tape cartridge is initialized when it is first loaded into a compatible tape drive and data is
written by the ISV application at the beginning of tape. The tape drive establishes the density
of the media at that time.
Cartridges should only be mounted in LTO 8 tape drives. M8 cartridges that are
inadvertently initialized at the L7 density can continue to be read and written in LTO 7 and
LTO 8 tape drives, but they will remain limited to the 6 TB native capacity.
The TS4500 tape library requires a minimum firmware version of 1.4.1.2. The drive needs a
minimum LTO 8 tape drive firmware version of HB82 to support un-initialized M8 cartridges
and to support for pre-initialized M8 cartridges.
Connectivity
The LTO-8 tape drive family offers high capacity, performance, and technology for the
midrange open systems environment. These tape drives are dual-ported tape drives that
facilitate 8 Gbps Fibre Channel connectivity. These drives are differentiated from other LTO
drives by their machine type and model numbers. You can identify the LTO tape drives by the
logo at the front of the drive or by the label at the rear of the drive’s canister.
IBM LTO-8 tape drives can connect to many types of servers. For a list of server interface
cards or host bus adapters (HBAs) that are supported by the LTO tape drives, see the IBM
System Storage Interoperation Center (SSIC) web page:
http://www.ibm.com/systems/support/storage/ssic
Performance
The LTO Ultrium 7 tape drive uses 3584 data tracks to read and write to Ultrium 8 tape. These
tracks are grouped in four servo bands. The high-bandwidth servo system features a
low-mass servo to help more effectively track servo bands and improve data throughput with
damaged media in less-than-optimal shock and vibration environments.
The native data transfer rate for Ultrium 8 tape drives is 360 MBps. Compressed data rates
can reach a peak rate of 800 MBps on the FC interface. IBM suggests the use of the IBM LTO
Ultrium 8 12 TB data cartridge, which provides up to 30 TB of storage with a 2.5:1
compression ratio.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 145
Dynamic speed matching
The LTO Ultrium 8 tape drive performs dynamic speed matching at one of 12 speeds to adjust
the native data rate of the drive as closely as possible to the net host data rate (after it factors
out data compressibility). This approach helps to reduce the number of backhitch repositions
and improves throughput performance. Backhitching is the condition that occurs when a data
cartridge stops, reverses, and restarts motion. A backhitch is the result of a mismatch
between the data rates of the connected server and the tape drive.
Table 2-21 lists the data rates for the LTO Ultrium 8 drives.
Encryption
The LTO Ultrium 8 tape drive family is encryption-capable and supports application-managed
tape encryption at no charge on Fibre Channel tape drives. For library use, system-managed
tape encryption and library-managed tape encryption are supported by the Transparent LTO
Encryption features (FC 5901 for TS2900, FC 1604 for TS3500, and FC 5900 for all other
libraries). IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager is required for encryption key management
with LTO Ultrium 8 drives.
LTFS provides a standard tape cartridge format at low cost that can be used without other
database applications. LTFS presents tape media as though it were a disk file system. IBM
Spectrum Archive supports the IBM LTO Ultrium 8, 7, 6, and 5, and IBM TS1155, TS1150,
and TS1140 tape drives. IBM Spectrum Archive supports the LTO-7 initialized LTO-8 Type M
cartridge. For more information, see “M8 format media” on page 144.
With LTFS, accessing data that is stored on an IBM tape cartridge became as easy and
intuitive as using a USB flash drive. With LTFS file manager, reading data on a tape cartridge
is as easy as dragging and dropping. Users can run any application that is designed for disk
files against tape data without concern that the data is physically stored on tape.
LTFS implements a true file system for tape. LTFS also supports library automation, including
the ability to find data on a tape in a library without mounting and searching tape volumes.
IBM Spectrum Archive supports IBM tape automation in addition to the single drive edition.
By using IBM Spectrum Archive Library Edition, you can create a single file system mount
point for a logical library that is managed by a single instance of the software, which runs on a
single server. In addition, it provides for caching of tape indexes and for searching, querying,
and displaying tapes’ contents within an IBM tape library without the requirement to mount
tape cartridges.
For more information about IBM Spectrum Archive and LTFS, see 2.10, “IBM Spectrum
Archive” on page 162.
The Ultrium 7 tape drive is a high-performance, high-capacity tape drive. The drive records
data by using a linear serpentine recording format on half-inch tape that is housed within a
cartridge. The data tracks are located by using preformatted servo tracks.
The Ultrium 7 tape drive provides the following improvements over the older Ultrium 6 models:
The Ultrium 7 tape drive increases the native transfer speed to 300 MBps compared with
160 MBps for the Ultrium 6 tape drive.
The Ultrium 7 tape drive increases the compressed speed to 700 MBps for Fibre Channel
compared with 400 MBps for the Ultrium 6 tape drive.
The Ultrium 7 tape drive more than doubles the potential capacity of a cartridge in Ultrium
6 format.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 147
Sixteen KB cartridge memory with Ultrium 7 media
IBM Spectrum Archive Single Drive Edition, Library Edition, and Enterprise Edition
support
Linear Tape File System (LTFS) partitioning support
The LTO Ultrium 7 supports integration in the IBM TS4500 library by using a new compact
drive sled.
The LTO Ultrium 7 Model F7C back panel is the same back panel that is used in LTO-6 and
LTO-5, as shown in Figure 2-30.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 149
Table 2-22 describes all of the components on the rear panel and shows the normal status of
the LEDs. The numbers in Table 2-22 refer to the numbers that are shown in Figure 2-30 on
page 149.
8 Port 0, 8 Gbps fiber connection Supports N_ports and NL_ports, which can
autoconfigure between using the FC-AL
protocol and the Direct Fabric attach protocol
9 Port 1, 8 Gbps fiber connection Supports N_ports and NL_ports, which can
autoconfigure between using the FC-AL
protocol and the Direct Fabric attach protocol
Compatibility
In addition to reading and writing to LTO Ultrium 7 tape cartridges, the Ultrium 7 tape drives
can read and write to LTO Ultrium 6 cartridges and read LTO Ultrium 5 cartridges. They
cannot read Ultrium 4, Ultrium 3, Ultrium 2, or Ultrium 1 cartridges.
The drive also writes to tapes that can be read by other licensed LTO Ultrium 7 drives. In
addition to using the IBM LTO Ultrium Data Cartridge with up to 6 TB capacity, the drive offers
read/write capability for certified LTO Ultrium 7 tape cartridges.
Note: The LTO-7 tape drive cannot read or write LTO-1, LTO-2, LTO-3, or LTO-4 tape
cartridges.
Table 2-23 lists the native data transfer rate when a data cartridge of another generation is
processed.
Connectivity
The LTO-7 tape drive family offers high capacity, performance, and technology for the
midrange open systems environment. These tape drives are dual-ported tape drives that
facilitate 8 Gbps Fibre Channel connectivity. These drives are differentiated from other LTO
drives by their machine type and model numbers. You can identify the LTO tape drives by the
logo at the front of the drive or by the label at the rear of the drive’s canister.
IBM LTO-7 tape drives can connect to many types of servers. For a list of server interface
cards or host bus adapters (HBAs) that are supported by the LTO tape drives, see the IBM
System Storage Interoperation Center (SSIC) web page:
http://www.ibm.com/systems/support/storage/ssic
Performance
The LTO Ultrium 7 tape drive uses 3584 data tracks to read and write to Ultrium 7 tape. These
tracks are grouped in four servo bands. The high-bandwidth servo system features a
low-mass servo to help more effectively track servo bands and improve data throughput with
damaged media in less-than-optimal shock and vibration environments.
The native data transfer rate for Ultrium 7 tape drives is 300 MBps. Compressed data rates
can reach up to 750 MBps on the FC interface and 600 MBps on the serial-attached SCSI
(SAS) interface. IBM suggests the use of the IBM LTO Ultrium 7 6 TB data cartridge, which
provides up to 10 TB of storage with a 2.5:1 compression ratio.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 151
Table 2-24 lists the data rates for the LTO Ultrium 7 drives.
Encryption
The LTO Ultrium 7 tape drive family is encryption-capable and supports application-managed
tape encryption at no charge on the SAS and Fibre Channel tape drives. In library use,
system-managed tape encryption and library-managed tape encryption are supported by the
Transparent LTO Encryption features (FC 5901 for TS2900, FC 1604 for TS3500, and FC
5900 for all other libraries). IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager is required for encryption key
management with LTO Ultrium 6 drives.
Tape as a storage medium offers many benefits. It is reliable, portable, low-cost, low-power,
and high-capacity. However, tape is not particularly easy to use. Tape has no standard format,
and data often cannot be used without first copying the data to disk.
With LTFS, accessing data that is stored on an IBM tape cartridge became as easy and
intuitive as using a USB flash drive. With LTFS file manager, reading data on a tape cartridge
is as easy as dragging and dropping. Users can run any application that is designed for disk
files against tape data without concern that the data is physically stored on tape.
IBM Spectrum Archive supports IBM tape automation in addition to the single drive edition.
By using IBM Spectrum Archive Library Edition, you can create a single file system mount
point for a logical library that is managed by a single instance of the software, which runs on a
single server. In addition, it provides for caching of tape indexes and for searching, querying,
and displaying tapes’ contents within an IBM tape library without the requirement to mount
tape cartridges.
For more information about IBM Spectrum Archive and LTFS, see 2.10, “IBM Spectrum
Archive” on page 162.
The 3588 F6C tape drive is a high-performance, high-capacity tape drive. The drive records
data by using a linear serpentine recording format on half-inch tape that is housed within a
cartridge. The data tracks are located by using preformatted servo tracks.
The 3588 F6C tape drive provides the following improvements over the older LTO models:
The 3588 F6C tape drive increases the native transfer speed to 160 MBps compared with
140 MBps for the LTO-5 tape drive.
The 3588 F6C tape drive increases the compressed speed to 400 MBps compared with
280 MBps for the LTO-5 tape drive.
The 3588 F6C tape drive more than doubles the potential capacity of a cartridge in LTO-5
format.
The LTO Ultrium 6 supports integration in the IBM TS4500 library by using a compact drive
sled.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 153
The TS4500 LTO drive sled is shown in Figure 2-31.
The LTO Ultrium 6 Model F6C drive has a front bezel with a chevron fiducial. The buttons and
display remain the same as for all previous models of LTO drives, and the buttons and display
are the same as the LTO Ultrium 7 that is shown in Figure 2-26 on page 142.
Compatibility
In addition to reading and writing to LTO-6 tape cartridges, the LTO 6 tape drives can read
and write to LTO-5 tape cartridges and read LTO-4 tape cartridges.
Note: The LTO-6 tape drive cannot read or write to LTO-3, LTO-2, or LTO-1 tape
cartridges.
The drive also writes to tapes that can be read by other licensed LTO-6 drives. In addition to
using the IBM LTO Tape Cartridge with up to 2.5 TB capacity, the drive offers read/write
capability for certified LTO-6 tape cartridges.
Table 2-25 lists the native data transfer rate when a data cartridge of another generation is
processed.
IBM LTO-6 tape drives can connect to many types of servers. For a list of server interface
cards or host bus adapters (HBAs) that are supported by the LTO tape drives, see the IBM
System Storage Interoperation Center (SSIC) web page:
http://www.ibm.com/systems/support/storage/ssic
The LTO Ultrium 6 Model F6C has a new back panel, as shown in Figure 2-32.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 155
Table 2-26 describes all of the components on the rear panel and shows the normal status of
the LEDs. The numbers in Table 2-26 refer to the numbers that are shown in Figure 2-32 on
page 155.
8 Port 0, 8 Gbps fiber connection Supports N_ports and NL_ports, which can
autoconfigure between using the FC-AL
protocol and the Direct Fabric attach protocol
9 Port 1, 8 Gbps fiber connection Supports N_ports and NL_ports, which can
autoconfigure between using the FC-AL
protocol and the Direct Fabric attach protocol
Performance
The LTO-6 tape drive uses 2,176 data tracks to read and write to an LTO-6 tape cartridge.
These tracks are grouped in five servo bands. Like the LTO-5 tape drives, the high-bandwidth
servo system features a low-mass servo to help more effectively track servo bands and
improve data throughput with damaged media in less-than-optimal shock and vibration
environments.
The native data transfer rate for LTO-6 tape drives is 160 MBps. Compressed data rates can
reach 400 MBps. IBM suggests the use of the IBM LTO-6 2.5 TB tape cartridge, which
provides up to 6.25 TB of storage with a 2.5:1 compression ratio.
The LTO-6 tape drives are encryption capable, which means that they can convert data into a
cipher that ensures data security. System-managed encryption and library-managed
encryption and associated IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager (SKLM) access are all
available as a chargeable licensed key (FC 1604, Transparent LTO Encryption). A key is
required to encrypt and decrypt the data. How a key is generated, maintained, controlled, and
transmitted depends on the operating environment where the tape drive is installed.
Certain data management applications can manage keys. For an alternative solution, IBM
provides a key manager that works with the keystore of your choice to perform all necessary
key management tasks. No recovery exists for lost encryption keys.
LTO-6 tape drives use flangeless rollers so that the media can float naturally. The Surface
Control Guiding Mechanism helps to reduce tape damage (especially to the edges of the
tape) and tape debris that comes from the damaged edges and can accumulate in the head
area.
Media partitioning
Media partitioning is now available with the LTO-6 tape drive. Media partitioning allows for
faster data access by splitting the cartridge into two media partitions. WORM media is not
partitionable.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 157
IBM Spectrum Archive software application
IBM Ultrium 6 tape drives are compatible with the IBM Spectrum Archive software application.
IBM Spectrum Archive and the underlying Linear Tape File System (LTFS) use the LTO
Ultrium 6 and Ultrium 5 media partitioning functionality. LTFS provides a standard tape
cartridge format at low cost, and it can be used without other database applications. LTFS
presents tape media as though it were a file system on a disk drive. LTFS supports only IBM
IBM LTO Ultrium 8, 7, 6, and 5, and IBM TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140 tape drives.
Tape as a storage medium has many benefits. Tape is reliable, portable, low-cost, low-power,
and high-capacity. However, tape is not particularly easy to use. It has no standard format,
and data often cannot be used without first copying the data to disk.
With LTFS, accessing data that is stored on an IBM tape cartridge became as easy and
intuitive as using a USB flash drive. With LTFS file manager, reading data on a tape cartridge
is as easy as dragging and dropping. Users can run any application that is designed for disk
files against tape data without concern that the data is physically stored on tape.
LTFS implements a true file system for tape. LTFS also supports library automation, including
the ability to find data on a tape in a library without mounting and searching tape volumes.
IBM Spectrum Archive supports IBM tape automation in addition to the single drive edition.
By using IBM Spectrum Archive Library Edition, you can create a single file system mount
point for a logical library that is managed by a single instance of the software, which runs on a
single server. In addition, it provides for caching of tape indexes and for searching, querying,
and displaying tapes’ contents within an IBM tape library without the requirement to mount
tape cartridges.
For more information about IBM Spectrum Archive and LTFS, see 2.10, “IBM Spectrum
Archive” on page 162.
The LTO-5 tape drive is a high-performance, high-capacity tape drive. The drive records data
by using a linear serpentine recording format on half-inch tape that is housed within a
cartridge. The data tracks are located by using preformatted servo tracks.
The LTO-5 tape drive is physically the same as the LTO-6 tape drive, as shown in Figure 2-31
on page 154, except the only physical difference is that the rear panel shows as an LTO-5
tape drive, as shown in Figure 2-33.
Connectivity
The LTO-5 tape drive family offers high capacity, performance, and technology for the
midrange open systems environment. These tape drives are dual-ported tape drives that
facilitate 8 Gbps Fibre Channel connectivity. These tape drives are differentiated from other
LTO tape drives by their machine type and model numbers. You can identify the LTO tape
drives by the logo at the front of the drive or by the label at the rear of the drive’s canister.
IBM LTO tape drives can connect to many types of servers. For a list of server interface cards
or host bus adapters (HBAs) that are supported by the LTO tape drives, see the IBM System
Storage Interoperation Center (SSIC) web page:
http://www.ibm.com/systems/support/storage/ssic
The LTO Ultrium 5 Model F5C back panel is the same as the one for the LTO Ultrium 6, which
is shown in Figure 2-32 on page 155. All indicators and LEDs are the same as described in
Table 2-26 on page 156.
Compatibility
In addition to reading and writing to LTO-5 tape cartridges, the LTO-5 tape drives can read
and write to LTO-4 tape cartridges and read LTO-3 tape cartridges. However, the LTO-5 tape
drive cannot read LTO-2 or LTO-1 tape cartridges.
The drive also writes to tapes that can be read by other licensed LTO-5 tape drives. In
addition to the use of the IBM LTO Tape Cartridge with up to 1.5 TB capacity, the drive offers
read/write capability for certified LTO-5 tape cartridges.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 159
Table 2-28 lists the native data transfer rate when a tape cartridge of another generation is
processed.
The LTO-5 tape drive family offers high capacity, performance, and technology for the
midrange open systems environment. The LTO-6 tape drive (Model 3588 F6C) provides
dual-ported 8 Gbps Fibre Channel connectivity for point-to-point or Fibre Channel Arbitrated
Loop (FC-AL) attachment.
IBM LTO tape drives can connect to many types of servers. For a list of server interface cards
or HBAs that are supported by the LTO tape drives, see the IBM System Storage
Interoperation Center (SSIC) web page:
http://www.ibm.com/systems/support/storage/ssic
Performance
The LTO-5 tape drive uses 1,280 data tracks to read and write to the LTO-5 tape cartridge.
These tracks are grouped in five servo bands. Like the LTO-4 tape drives, the high-bandwidth
servo system features a low-mass servo to help more effectively track servo bands and
improve data throughput with damaged media in less-than-optimal shock and vibration
environments.
The native data transfer rate for LTO-5 tape drives is 140 MBps. Compressed data rates can
reach 280 MBps. IBM advises the use of the IBM LTO-5 1.5 TB tape cartridge, which provides
up to 3.0 TB of storage with a 2:1 compression ratio.
Media partitioning
Media partitioning is now available with the LTO-5 drive. Media partitioning allows for faster
data access by splitting the cartridge into two media partitions. WORM media is not
partitionable.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 161
IBM Spectrum Archive software application
The IBM Spectrum Archive software application and the underlying Linear Tape File System
(LTFS) use the LTO Ultrium Generation 5 media partitioning functionality. LTFS provides a
standard tape cartridge format at low cost, and it can be used without more database
applications. LTFS presents tape media as though it were a file system on a disk drive. It
supports only IBM LTO Ultrium 5 tape drives or higher-generation IBM LTO Ultrium tape
drives.
Tape as a storage medium has many benefits. Tape is reliable, portable, low-cost, low-power,
and high-capacity. However, tape is not particularly easy to use. It has no standard format,
and data often cannot be used without first copying the data to disk.
With LTFS, accessing data that is stored on an IBM tape cartridge became as intuitive as the
use of a USB flash drive. With LTFS file manager, reading data on a tape cartridge is as easy
as dragging and dropping. You can run any application that is designed for disk files against
tape data without concern that the data is physically stored on tape.
LTFS, which works on IBM LTO-8, 7, 6, 5, and IBM TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140
tape drives, implements a true file system for tape. LTFS also supports library automation,
including the ability to find data on a tape in a library without mounting and searching tape
volumes.
IBM Spectrum Archive supports IBM tape automation in addition to the single drive edition.
With IBM Spectrum Archive Library Edition, you can create a single file system mount point
for a logical library that is managed by a single instance of the software, which is running on a
single computer system. In addition, it provides for caching of tape indexes, and for searching,
querying, and displaying tapes’ contents within an IBM tape library without the requirement to
mount tape cartridges.
For more information about IBM Spectrum Archive and LTFS, see 2.10, “IBM Spectrum
Archive” on page 162.
IBM Spectrum Archive eliminates the need for additional tape management and software to
access data.
IBM Spectrum Archive offers three software solutions for managing your digital files with the
LTFS format: Single Drive Edition (SDE), Library Edition (LE), and Enterprise Edition (EE).
With IBM Spectrum Archive Enterprise Edition and IBM Spectrum Scale™, a tape tier can
now add savings as a low-cost storage tier. Network-attached unstructured data storage with
native tape support by using LTFS delivers the best mix of performance and low-cost storage.
Benefits
IBM Spectrum Archive enables direct, intuitive, and graphical access to data that is stored in
IBM tape drives and libraries by incorporating the LTFS format standard for reading, writing,
and exchanging descriptive metadata on formatted tape cartridges.IBM Spectrum Archive
eliminates the need for additional tape management and software to access data.
IBM Spectrum Archive takes advantage of the low cost of tape storage and makes it as easy
to use as drag-and-drop. Several IBM Spectrum Archive benefits are listed:
Enable easy-as-disk access to single or multiple cartridges in a tape library
Improve efficiency and reduce costs for long-term, tiered storage
Optimize data placement for cost and performance
Enable data file sharing without proprietary software
Scale at a low cost
Access and manage all data in stand-alone tape environments as simply as though the
data was on disk
LTFS is the first file system that works with LTO generation 8, 7, 6, 5, TS1160, TS1155,
TS1150, and TS1140 tape technology, to set a new standard for ease of use and portability
for open systems tape storage. With this application, accessing data that is stored on an IBM
tape cartridge is as easy and intuitive as using a USB flash drive. Tapes are self-describing,
and you can quickly recall any file from a tape without reading the whole tape from beginning
to end.
Furthermore, any LTFS-capable system can read a tape that is created by any other
LTFS-capable system (regardless of the operating system platform). Any LTFS-capable
system can identify and retrieve the files that are stored on it. LTFS-capable systems have the
following characteristics:
Files and directories are displayed to you as a directory tree listing.
More intuitive searches of cartridges and library content are now possible due to the
addition of file tagging.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 163
Files can be moved to and from LTFS tape by using the familiar drag-and-drop technique
that is common to many operating systems.
Many applications that were written to use files on disk can now use files on tape without
any modification.
All standard File Open, Write, Read, Append, Delete, and Close functions are supported.
Archival data storage requirements are growing at over 60% annually. The LTFS format is an
ideal option for long-term archiving of large files that need to be easily shared with other
individuals. This option is important because the LTO tape media that LTFS uses are
designed for a 15-year to 30-year lifespan (depending on the number of read/write passes).
Industries that benefit from this tape file system are the banking, digital media, medical,
geophysical, and entertainment industries. Many users in these industries use Linux or iOS
(Apple) systems, which are fully compatible with LTFS.
Important: LTO Ultrium cartridges from earlier LTO generations (that is, LTO-1 through
LTO-4) are not partitionable. Therefore, they cannot be used by LTFS. If LTO Ultrium 4
cartridges are used in an LTO Ultrium 5 drive to write data, the LTO-4 cartridge is treated
like an unpartitioned LTO-5 cartridge. Even if an application can work with partitions, it is
not possible to partition the LTO-4 media that is mounted at an LTO Ultrium 5 drive.
Similarly, WORM cartridges of any generation cannot be used by LTFS because they
cannot be partitioned.
The TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140 tape drives are also supported by IBM Spectrum
Archive SDE, IBM Spectrum Archive LE, and IBM Spectrum Archive EE.
Although LTFS presents the tape cartridge as a disk drive, the underlying hardware is still a
tape cartridge and sequential in nature. Tape does not allow random access. Data is always
appended to the tape, and no overwriting of files occurs. File deletions do not erase the data
from tape but simply erase the pointers to the data.
So, although with LTFS, you can simultaneously copy two (or more) files to an LTFS tape, you
get better performance if you copy files sequentially.
To operate the tape file system, the following components are necessary:
Software in the form of an open source LTFS package
Data structures that are created by LTFS on tape
Hardware that consists of IBM LTO-8, LTO-7, LTO-6, LTO-5, TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, or
TS1140 tape drives and tape media
Together, these components can handle a file system on LTO media as though it is a disk file
system for accessing tape files, including the tape directory tree structures. The metadata of
each cartridge, after it is mounted, is cached in server memory. Therefore, metadata
operations, such as browsing the directory or searching for a file name, do not require any
tape movement and they are quick.
With LTFS, accessing data that is stored on an IBM tape cartridge became as easy and
intuitive as the use of a USB flash drive. With LTFS file manager, reading data on a tape
cartridge is as easy as dragging and dropping a file. Users can run any application that is
designed for disk files against tape data without concern that the data is physically stored on
tape.
With IBM Spectrum Archive Single Drive Edition, you can create a single file system mount
point for a logical library that is managed by a single instance of LTFS, which is running on a
single computer system. In addition, it provides for caching of tape indexes, and for searching,
querying, and displaying tapes’ contents within an IBM tape library without the requirement to
mount tape cartridges.
For more information about IBM Spectrum Archive SDE, see IBM Linear Tape File System
Installation and Configuration, SG24-8090.
The TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140 provide LTFS support with the following
features:
They provide the capability to configure up to four partitions.
They support wrap-wise and longitudinal-wise partitioning.
They support all non-WORM media formats.
They provide format command support.
Each partition can use a separate encryption method, or none.
The TS1160, TS1155, and TS1150 drives support partitioning in an identical manner to the
TS1140, except the capacity of a specific partition scales up with the newly supported J5 and
J5A format and improved performance:
These drives support both the wrap-wise and longitudinal partitioning models and the
same number of partitions.
These drives support the partitioning of WORM media types to enable LTFS support on
WORM media.
These drives support a default wrap-wise partitioning model with minimal capacity loss at
the expense of Accumulating Backhitchless Flush (ABF) capability within all partitions at
all times.
Partitioning allows a volume to be split into multiple logical partitions, each of which can be
read, navigated, written, erased, appended, updated, and managed as separate logical
entities, with unique logical block sequences.
The primary user of this partitioning capability is LTFS, which partitions a volume into two
logical partitions: an index partition and a data partition. The TS1160, TS1155, and TS1150
drives support both TS1140 style partitions.
The TS1160, TS1155, and TS1150 support more partitioning enhancements over the
TS1140, specifically, both wrap-wise partitioning and longitudinal partitioning methods.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 165
The following characteristics apply in general to partitioning support on the TS1160, (3592
60E and 60F), TS1155 (3592 55E and 55F), and TS1150 (3592 EH8):
Partitioning is supported on media in the TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140 logical
formats.
In JC media reuse, if you issue a Format Medium command, the system performs an
implicit reformat to the drive format where the media is mounted; therefore, if TS1150 is
used, it formats in TS1160 format if the media is in the TS1150 format.
In JD media reuse, if you issue a Format Medium command, the system performs an
implicit reformat to the TS1155 format, if the media is in the TS1150 format.
Partitioning is only supported on unscaled R/W data and WORM media types that support
writing in the TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, or TS1140 format.
In scaled media, the Format Medium command is rejected.
Attempts to scale partitioned media are accepted. As part of scaling, the volume is set to a
single data partition cartridge.
For more information about partitioning behavior, see IBM 3592 SCSI Reference,
GA32-0562:
http://www.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=ssg1S7003248&aid=1
Wrap-wise partitioning
LTO-8, 7, 6, and 5 support two wrap-wise partitions. The TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and
TS1140 support four wrap-wise partitions.
Figure 2-34 on page 167 shows wrap-wise partitioning. The following information applies to
wrap-wise partitioning:
A maximum of four partitions are supported. Two or three partitions can be assigned, if
preferred.
A minimum of two wraps are allocated to a partition, regardless of the minimum selected
capacity.
The full length of the tape (LP3 to LP5) is always assigned to each partition.
In general, two physical wraps between partitions are reserved as guard wraps. Therefore,
a percentage of usable capacity might be lost, up to 3% for each partition boundary.
RABF operations are performed in any partition if spare usable ABF wraps exist within a
partition. In general, the last four wraps of a partition, or any partition that is smaller than
four wraps, do not support RABF operations.
Longitudinal partitioning
The following conditions apply to longitudinal partitioning, which is supported on the TS1155,
TS1150, and TS1140, TS1160:
Note: For TS1160 using the new JE/JV/JM media types, wrap-wise partitioning is
supported but longitudinal partitioning is not.
For other media types (JD/JZ/JL and JC/JY/JK), the TS1160 drive will continue to support
both the wrap-wise and longitudinal partitioning models, similar to the E08 drive.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 167
2.10.2 IBM Spectrum Archive Editions
As shown in Figure 2-36, IBM Spectrum Archive is available in three editions that support
small, medium, and enterprise businesses.
NFS/CIFS
NFS/CIFS
IBM Spectrum Scale
File system
Linux or Windows Server
Disk file system
IBM Spectrum Archive Library Edition
IBM Spectrum Archive Single Drive Edition file system works with LTO generation 8, 7, 6, 5,
TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and TS1140 tape technology to set a new standard for
ease-of-use and portability for open systems tape storage. These tape drives support media
partitioning, which allows their media to be divided in segments. Accessibility is improved
because you can quickly locate data to retrieve or update.
LTFS can write files directly to tape media without any specific application. The tape drive
shows up on the operating system as though it were a USB-attached drive. With LTFS file
manager, reading data on a tape cartridge is as easy as dragging and dropping. Users can
run any application that is designed for disk files against tape data without concern that the
data is physically stored on tape.
For more information about IBM Spectrum Archive SDE, see IBM Linear Tape File System
Installation and Configuration, SG24-8090.
LTFS is the first file system that works with IBM System Storage tape technology to optimize
ease of use and portability for open systems tape storage. It manages the automation and
provides operating system-level access to the contents of the library. IBM Spectrum Archive
LE is based on the LTFS format specification, enabling tape library cartridges to be
interchangeable with cartridges that are written with the open source SDE version of IBM
Spectrum Archive. IBM Spectrum Archive LE supports most IBM tape libraries:
TS2900 tape autoloader
TS3100 tape library
TS3200 tape library
TS3310 tape library
TS4300 tape library
TS3500 tape library
TS4500 tape library
IBM TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and IBM TS1140 tape drives are supported on IBM TS4500,
and TS1160, TS1150, and TS1140 are supported on the IBM TS3500 tape libraries only.
IBM Spectrum Archive LE enables the reading, writing, searching, and indexing of user data
on tape and access to user metadata. Metadata is the descriptive information about user data
that is stored on a cartridge. Metadata enables searching and accessing of files through the
GUI of the operating system. IBM Spectrum Archive LE supports both Linux and Windows.
The IBM Spectrum Archive LE offers the same basic capabilities as the SDE with additional
support of tape libraries. Each LTFS tape cartridge in the library appears as an individual
folder within the file space. The user or application can navigate into each of these folders to
access the files that are stored on each tape. The IBM Spectrum Archive LE software
automatically controls the tape library robotics to load and unload the necessary LTFS
volumes to provide access to the stored files.
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 169
Figure 2-37 shows how IBM Spectrum Archive LE presents the tapes in the library as folders.
The following IBM tape libraries and tape autoloader support IBM Spectrum Archive LE:
TS2900 tape autoloader
TS3100 tape library
TS3200 tape library
TS3310 tape library
TS4300 tape library
TS3500 tape library
TS4500 tape library
For more information about IBM Spectrum Archive LE, see IBM Linear Tape File System
Installation and Configuration, SG24-8090.
With IBM Spectrum Archive EE, you can enable the use of LTFS for the policy management
of tape as a storage tier in an IBM Spectrum Scale environment and use tape as a critical tier
in the storage environment. IBM Spectrum Archive EE supports IBM Linear Tape-Open (LTO)
Ultrium 8, 7, 6, and 5 tape drives, and IBM System Storage TS1160, TS1155, TS1150, and
TS1140 tape drives that are installed in TS4500 and TS3500 tape libraries or LTO Ultrium 8,
7, 6, and 5 tape drives that are installed in the TS3310 tape library or LTO Ultrium 8, 7, and 6
tape drives that are installed in the TS4300 tape library.
The use of IBM Spectrum Archive EE to replace disks with tape in tier 2 and tier 3 storage can
improve data access over other storage solutions because it improves efficiency and
streamlines the management for files on tape. IBM Spectrum Archive EE simplifies the use
of tape by making it transparent to the user and manageable by the administrator under a
single infrastructure.
Figure 2-38 shows the integration of the IBM Spectrum Archive EE archive solution with IBM
Spectrum Scale.
Figure 2-38 Integration of IBM Spectrum Scale and IBM Spectrum Archive Enterprise Edition
Chapter 2. TS4500 Ultrium Linear Tape-Open and 3592 tape drives 171
The seamless integration offers transparent file access in a continuous namespace. It
provides the following capabilities:
File-level write and read caching with a disk staging area
Policy-based movement from disk to tape
Creation of multiple data copies on different tapes
Load balancing and high availability in multiple node clusters
Data exchange on LTFS tape by using the import and export function
Fast import of file namespace from LTFS tapes without reading data
Built-in tape reclamation and reconciliation
Simple administration and management
Chapter 3. Encryption
The encryption policies, methods, and software capabilities for the IBM TS4500 tape library
are described in this chapter.
Encryption is performed at full line speed in the tape drive after compression. (Data is
compressed more efficiently before it is encrypted.) This capability adds a strong measure of
security to stored data without using processing power and without degrading performance.
IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager is the IBM strategic platform for the storage and delivery
of encryption keys to encrypt storage endpoint devices.
The IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager can be used to provide encryption key management
services for the encryption of data with encryption-capable drives. Host software has no direct
knowledge of the key manager that is used.
IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager serves data keys to the tape drive. The first release of
IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager focuses on ease of use and provides a new GUI to help
with the installation and configuration of the key manager. With IBM Security Key Lifecycle
Manager, the main encryption keys (certificates) can be created and managed. If you use the
IBM Tivoli® Key Lifecycle Manager, you can migrate to the new IBM Security Key Lifecycle
Manager.
For more detailed information about the IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager, see IBM
Knowledge Center for IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager:
https://www.ibm.com/support/knowledgecenter/en/SSWPVP
With the TS4500 tape library, the encryption policy is managed at the logical library level. The
Logical Libraries page of the TS4500 management GUI is used to enable encryption for a
logical library and modify the encryption method that is used. The Security page of the
TS4500 management GUI is used to manage key servers and key labels.
Note: In the tape storage environment, the encryption function on tape drives (desktop,
stand-alone, and within libraries) is configured and managed by the client. It is not
configured and managed by the IBM service support representative (SSR). In certain
instances, SSRs are required to enable encryption at a hardware level when service
access or service password-controlled access is required. Client setup support is from a
field technical sales specialist (FTSS), client documentation, and software support for
encryption software problems.
The encryption and decryption ciphers can be related by a simple transformation on the key,
or the encryption key and the decryption key can be identical. In the IBM Tape Encryption
solution IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager, the same encryption key is used for encryption
and decryption of the data. This key is protected by an asymmetric key algorithm, and it is
never available in clear text.
Symmetric key encryption is several orders of magnitude faster than asymmetric key
encryption. Secret key algorithms can support encryption 1 bit at a time or by specified blocks
of bits. The Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) supports 128-bit block sizes and key sizes
of 128, 192, and 256. The IBM Tape Encryption solution uses the AES standard with a 256-bit
key. Other well-known symmetric key examples are listed:
Twofish
Blowfish
Serpent
Cast5
Data Encryption Standard (DES)
This technique was pioneered in the 1970s, and it represented a significant breakthrough in
cryptography. The Rivest-Shamir-Adleman (RSA) algorithm is the most widely used public
key technique. The power of this approach is a public key, which is used to encrypt the data.
This public key can be widely shared, and anyone who wants to send secure data to an
organization can use its public key. The receiving organization then uses its private key to
decrypt the data, which makes public/private key encryption useful for sharing information
between organizations. This methodology is widely used on the internet today to secure
transactions, including Secure Sockets Layer (SSL).
Asymmetric key encryption is much slower and more computationally intensive than
symmetric key encryption. The advantage of asymmetric key encryption is the ability to share
secret data without sharing the same encryption key.
The TS4500 tape library supports the IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager. For more
information, see the IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager V3.0 documentation section in IBM
Knowledge Center:
https://www.ibm.com/support/knowledgecenter/en/SSWPVP_3.0.0.1/com.ibm.sklm.doc/wel
come.htm
The key manager operates on a number of operating systems, including IBM z/OS, Linux,
Sun Solaris, IBM AIX, and Microsoft Windows. It is a shared resource that is deployed in
several locations within an enterprise. It can serve numerous IBM encrypting tape drives, or
encrypting disk drives, regardless of where those drives are installed (for example, in tape
library subsystems, which are connected to mainframe systems through various types of
channel connections, or installed in other computing systems).
The key manager uses a keystore to hold the certificates and keys (or pointers to the
certificates and keys) that are required for all encryption tasks. Refer to the appropriate
documentation for detailed information about the key manager and the keystores that it
supports.
The following methods are available to manage encryption in the TS4500 tape library:
Application-managed encryption (AME)
System-managed encryption (SME) for TS7700 z/OS
Library-managed encryption (LME)
Key management and the encryption policy engine can be in any of the environment layers
that are shown in Figure 3-1.
Figure 3-1 Possible locations for the encryption policy engine and key management
The application layer, for example, IBM Spectrum Protect, initiates the data transfer for tape
storage.
The library layer is the TS4500 tape library, which contains an internal interface to each tape
drive that is installed in the library.
Note: The capability to use AME is not preset. The logical library must be set to use AME.
Application-managed tape encryption can use either of two encryption command sets:
The IBM encryption command set that was developed for the key manager
The T10 command set that was defined by the International Committee for Information
Technology Standards (INCITS)
After the TS7700 uses drives for encrypted physical tape volumes, it will place drives that are
not correctly enabled for encryption offline to the subsystem.
System-managed encryption is best where the applications that write to or read from tapes
are not capable of performing the key management that is required for application-managed
encryption.
For IBM z Systems, encryption policies that specify when to use encryption can be set up in
the z/OS Data Facility Storage Management Subsystem (DFSMS) or implicitly through each
instance of an IBM device driver. Key generation and management are performed by an
encryption key server. Policy controls and keys pass through the data path between the
system layer and the encrypting tape drives. Encryption is transparent to the applications.
Note: The capability to use LME is not preset. The logical library must be set to use LME.
Key generation and management are performed by the key manager, which is a Java
application that is running on a library-attached host. The keys pass through the
library-to-drive interface. Therefore, encryption is transparent to the applications when it is
used with certain applications, such as IBM Spectrum Protect.
Bar code encryption policies, which are set up through the TS4500 management GUI, can be
used to specify when to use encryption. In such cases, policies are based on cartridge
volume serial numbers (VOLSERs). Library-managed encryption also allows other options,
such as the encryption of all volumes in a library, independently of bar codes. Key generation
and management are performed by the key manager. Policy control and keys pass through
the library-to-drive interface. Therefore, encryption is not apparent to the applications.
Up to four library-managed encryption (LME) key paths per logical library are supported on
the TS4500.
Note: If you use LME and IBM device drivers that run on open systems platforms (AIX,
Linux, Solaris, or Windows), information for bulk rekey is available in the IBM Tape Device
Drivers Installation and User’s Guide, GC27-2130. This guide is available on the web:
http://www.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=ssg1S7002972
When you use LME, an extra Ethernet cable must be attached, preferably to a different
network switch. The extra cable is for redundancy and better backup job reliability.
3.2.6 Prerequisites for using encryption on the IBM TS4500 tape library
Certain hardware and software prerequisites must be met before you use encryption with the
TS4500 tape library.
With the TS4500 tape library, encryption is managed at the logical library level. All
encryption-enabled drives that are assigned to a logical library use the same method of
encryption.
The rules for setting up encryption differ based on whether the library is installed with 3592 or
LTO tape drives, and whether you use library-managed encryption (LME), system-managed
encryption (SME), or application-managed encryption (AME).
If the library contains 3592 tape drives, the following prerequisites apply:
IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager must be attached to the TS4500 and configured for
LME.
Tape drives must be enabled for encryption from the Logical Libraries page of the TS4500
management GUI.
If the tape drives connect to a TS7700, system-managed encryption must be used.
If the library contains LTO tape drives, the following prerequisites apply:
Tape drives must be enabled for encryption from the Logical Libraries page of the TS4500
management GUI.
Feature Code (FC) 1604, Transparent LTO Encryption, is required for LTO tape drives if
you use LME.
IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager is required as the key manager when you use LME
with LTO tape drives.
To enable encryption or modify the method that is used, complete the following steps:
1. Select a logical library on the Logical Libraries page.
2. Select Actions → Modify Encryption Method.
3. Choose a method from the Encryption menu on the Modify Encryption Method window
and click Modify, as shown in Figure 3-2.
For more information about this topic, see “Modify Encryption Method” on page 289.
The IMC, which includes an LCD panel and a keyboard with a touchpad, can be mounted on
either end of the TS4500 tape library. A library controller card (LCC) and power source are
required within the end frame or within the adjacent frame. Alternatively, you can use the
Feature Code (FC) 2737, IMC Separate Power Source, to source IMC power independently
and to attach the IMC to an LCC anywhere in the library.
The IMC comes pre-installed with a system console application, which is a set of software
tools that is used for local service and remote support of the attached TS4500 tape library.
The system console application enables the IMC to provide service console capabilities, such
as broadband Call Home.
The TS4500 management GUI runs on a web browser in kiosk mode on the IMC. Kiosk
mode means that the menu bar, address bar, and stop and reload buttons of the browser are
disabled. In addition, it is not possible to use bookmarks or multiple browser windows.
Figure 4-1 shows the IMC.
Table 4-1 lists the components of the Tiny PC. The numbers correspond to the numbers that
are shown in Figure 4-2.
8 Power
9 DVD drive
During installation, the IBM service support representative (SSR) configures the IMC by using
network settings that are provided by the user. Static IP assignment is the default, but
Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) can be selected. For static IP assignment, the
user must provide the SSR with a listing of the values to enter in the network setup for the
library IP address, subnet mask, and gateway.
Mozilla Firefox 38
Google Chrome 43
a. IBM supports higher versions of the browsers as long as the vendors do not remove or
disable functionality that the product relies upon. For browser levels that are higher than the
versions that are certified with the product, customer support accepts usage-related and
defect-related service requests. As with operating system and virtualization environments,
if IBM Support cannot re-create the issue in our lab, IBM Support might ask the client to
re-create the problem on a certified browser version to determine whether a product defect
exists. Defects are not accepted for cosmetic differences between browsers or browser
versions that do not affect the functional behavior of the product. If a problem is identified
in the product, defects are accepted. If a problem is identified with the browser, IBM might
investigate potential solutions or workarounds that the client can implement until a
permanent solution becomes available.
2. Enter the Ethernet IP address of the frame on the URL line of the browser and press
Enter.
3. If users are set up, enter your user name and password and click Log in. If this installation
is new, log on to the TS4500 management GUI with the default user name and password
(User Name: admin and Password: admin) to continue with the setup. After you log on with
the default password, you must create a new password for the administrator account,
which changes the default password.
Important: Document the new administrator password because this password cannot
be recovered if additional administrator users are not set up.
Setup wizard
If the TS4500 is a new installation, use the Initial Setup wizard, as shown in Figure 4-4. This
wizard guides you through the basic configuration settings. The following settings are
configured when you use the Initial Setup wizard. You can modify these settings from the
Settings page of the management GUI.
2. In the next window, you can set the date and time for the library manually. Optionally, you
can synchronize with a Network Time Protocol (NTP) server, as shown in Figure 4-6.
3. Use the window that is shown in Figure 4-7 to configure a logical library, or you can skip
this step and configure the logical library later.
Table 4-3 lists all of the fields that are shown in the window. The numbers in Table 4-3 refer to
the numbers that are shown in Figure 4-9 on page 189.
4 Help.
7 Monitoring menu.
8 Library menu.
9 Drives menu.
10 Cartridges menu.
11 Access menu.
12 Settings menu.
13 Tasks icon. The Tasks icon displays when tasks are running.
14a The physical capacity pod displays the licensed capacity Linear Tape-Open (LTO) and
(3592). This pod changes color to yellow or red, depending on whether the capacity
exceeds the thresholds.
15 Switch the display to show the physical capacity per drive type by using the arrow on a
mixed library.
17a All installed frames and status. This area is grouped into four frames. When this area
is selected, the four frames show in the main window.
18a Library health status pod. The color of the health status pod indicates the current state
of the library by severity.
19 Frame health status pod for the selected frame. An icon is present in this field if an error
or warning exists with a frame, tape drive, cartridge, or an accessor. Hover over the icon
to see a list of the most important issues that cause this state. Click any issue to open
the Events Page to see more information.
20 Library events icon. The library events icon displays if events are active.
a. Status PODs. Pods are always located at the bottom of the System page and show a quick view of
capacity, drive utilization, and library health and changes color depending on the health or utilization
settings.
4.3.1 Library
Use the Library option to set the date and time of your library and to set whether to
automatically eject expired cleaning cartridges.
Each cleaning cartridge can be used approximately 50 times. The usage count is stored
internally in the cartage memory chip inside each cleaning cartridge and this prevents a used
cleaning cartridge to be reused.
The accessor service area consists of the storage slots that only one accessor can manage.
For more information, see “Elastic Capacity option” on page 20.
Modifying the accessor zone configuration is done using the TS4500 setAccessorZones CLI
command. This command can also be used to inactivate a accessor. This command is
described in “setAccessorZones” on page 352.
You are required to enter the license key in the license key code field. The license key file is
generated by manufacturing, and it is a unique number that is based on the serial number of
the library. Select the frame number and enter the license key, as shown in Figure 4-14.
Note: Advanced Library Management System (ALMS), which comes standard on the
TS4500, always shows as installed.
The following features are the extended library capabilities and they become available when
the license key is uploaded:
Path failover creates redundancy in the path from the application to the intended target
(the library accessor or the drive mechanism).
Intermediate high-density capacity on demand (HD CoD) increases storage from the entry
capacity to the intermediate capacity. The Intermediate CoD feature (FC 1643) adds 100
slots, increasing the usable capacity of the L25 and L55 frames to 200 slots.
Base capacity on demand (CoD) increases storage from the intermediate capacity to the
base capacity. The Base CoD feature (FC 1644) adds 200 slots, increasing the usable
capacity of the L25 and L55 frames to 400 slots.
LTO transparent encryption is required to enable encryption on LTO tape drives if you use
library-managed encryption (LME).
High-density capacity on demand (HD CoD) increases storage to use all of the tiers of an
HD frame. The initial capacity of the Dx5 frames is 500 slots. The initial capacity of the S25
frame is 600 slots. The initial capacity of the S55 frame is 660 slots. The HD CoD features
can add 50 - 660 more slots anywhere, depending on the frame position and
configuration. This license is required to be installed on each HD frame.
By selecting the Network option, the Ethernet Ports window opens, as shown in Figure 4-15,
which displays the current settings of all ports and displays their status.
Use this window to change the Internet Protocol (IP) address that you use to access the
management GUI. Individual frames and ports can be configured to use IPv4, IPv6, or both
types of IP addresses.
Use the Actions menu to modify an Ethernet port or display its properties, as shown in
Figure 4-16.
Use this window to change the IP address that you use to access the management GUI. You
can configure individual frames, and ports can be configured to use IPv4, IPv6, or both types
of IP addresses.
A link local address is an IP address that is intended only for communications within the
segment of a local network. The link local address is not configurable. IPv6 is enabled per
interface, and the IPv6 link local address is assigned to the interface where IPv6 is enabled.
Properties
This option displays the current configuration and link status of the selected port, as shown in
Figure 4-18.
Figure 4-19 shows the security setup options that are available for iSCSI.
The following are possible authentication settings for discovery and normal use:
Disabled, which is the default
CHAP enabled
CHAP and NONE enabled
NONE enabled
Note: Target authentication is disabled by default. Target user name and password are
required if using CHAP and Target authentication is enabled.
Library Information
The Library Information page displays the configured system name, system location, and
company contact information for the TS4500 tape library. The library information is sent in
Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), email, syslog, and Call Home notifications.
3. Use this window to set the TS4500 system name, system location, and company contact
details. The system name that is shown in the library information profile references the
system name that is set during the initial configuration of the library. The system name
appears in the navigation tree and notifications.
4. After you complete all of the settings, click OK to apply the changes.
3. To change the setting, select Modify, as shown in Figure 4-22, which opens the Modify
SNMP Settings window, as shown in Figure 4-23.
4. Select the SNMP state (Disabled or Enabled). When the SNMP state is disabled, the
TS4500 tape library does not send messages to the network-attached devices for
conditions that warrant administrative attention. When the SNMP status is enabled, the
library sends traps to automatically notify an administrator if an issue arises.
Note: Disabling SNMP does not delete any destinations that were set up.
SNMP traps enable the TS4500 tape library to send its profile to the SNMP server by way of
an unsolicited SNMP message. If an issue arises with the library, network, or any port in the
network, the tape library responds with an information profile to the SNMP server. The nature
of the profile depends on the type of issue that arose.
The SNMP community is the name of the class of users that can access the statistics of
network-attached devices. The trap community name is sent with a trap. For information
about the SNMP trap community name, see the documentation for your monitoring station. To
view or change the community name that is associated with the TS4500 tape library, click
Modify on the Modify SNMP Settings page (Figure 4-23 on page 201).
By default, the TS4500 tape library SNMP community is set to public. During the initial
system configuration, the administrator can change the community name and customize the
access settings for each community name.
SNMP Destinations
Use the SNMP Destinations window to configure SNMP destination servers, send test SNMP
traps, and download the SNMP Management Information Base (MIB) file. You can also
specify the type of messages (errors, warnings, or informational messages) that each SNMP
destination server receives:
1. From the SNMP Destinations window, select the Create Destination tab to display the
Add Destination window, as shown in Figure 4-24.
2. Enter the destination SNMP server IP address and port number that are used, with the
types of messages to send to the server.
3. Select Add to add the server and continue to create new servers if you require multiple
servers with different roles.
You can select errors, warnings, and informational messages to send to the SNMP server.
The SNMP MIB file is used to interpret SNMP traps. When the GUI receives an SNMP trap, it
compiles the SNMP trap into human-readable form so that you can gather information about
the error.
The many components in a network are made by various manufacturers, and each
component has unique properties and definitions. Data that is sent from the TS4500 tape
library to any of the devices must be translated to a protocol that is understood by the device.
An MIB file is a database that contains the properties and definitions of each
network-attached device. The MIB file receives and translates the data when the TS4500
tape library sends the request for information.
The following list shows all of the configuration data options that you can access for the frame
or system configuration (frame or module):
Logical Library
Drive Configuration
Library Configuration
VPD Note Card
Call Home Configuration
SNMP
Key Manager
Drive Encryption
SMTP configuration
Time Configuration
User Roles
Role Access Level
LDAP Configuration
Ethernet Configuration
To download the configuration MIB file, select SNMP Destinations, as shown in Figure 4-25.
Then, with the IP address highlighted, select Actions → Download SNMP MiB File.
3. After you complete all fields, click Test on the Modify Email Settings page. If the test is
successful, click Modify to save the settings.
You can define a specific email destination or a specific Short Message Service (SMS)
gateway to use certain SMTP gateways only.
SMTP dictates that every email message must specify the email address of the sender. This
sender address must be a valid address for two reasons:
Many SMTP gateways require a valid sender address as a security measure to prevent
unauthorized usage of the SMTP server. Otherwise, the SMTP gateway does not forward
the email. Often, this sender address must be limited to a specific domain.
The sender’s address is used as the destination for error messages, such as an incorrect
email address and a full email mailbox, that are generated by the SMTP gateways.
Note: The default SMTP server port value is set to 25, and can be changed to a secure
port such as 465. Many email serves no longer permit port 25 so check with your email
service provider or administrator for correct port to use.
3. You can add a number of recipients, based on their email addresses and local user
names. Specify the email address to which you want to send the events, or you can
optionally select a user if an email address was specified for that user when that user was
defined.
4. You can also select the type of alert that a specific user can receive. Select Create to
create an email recipient.
5. After a recipient is created, you can then modify the user, delete the user, or send a test
email to the user from the Actions menu, as shown in Figure 4-28.
When system events occur, the TS4500 tape library creates a log of these events. You can
configure the TS4500 tape library to send syslog notifications and send a notification of
the event to the syslog server. The syslog server keeps its own log of system events. (The
syslog server is a client-provided server.)
3. After the syslog server is set, you can use the Actions menu, as shown in Figure 4-30.
You can modify, delete, or send a test to the IP address of a syslog server.
4.3.4 Security
Use the Security page for the following functions:
Enable and configure remote authentication
Disable remote authentication
Set access rules
Enable or disable Secure Sockets Layer (SSL)
Manage encryption
If service credentials are not supported or not entered, the library uses the user credentials
to bind to and query the Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP)/Active Directory
(AD) server.
If the TS4500 user does not have sufficient privileges to query the LDAP server, the
TS4500 user authentication process fails. When service credentials (with the correct
privileges) are supported and entered into the settings, this error does not occur.
Authentication
With authentication, security tasks are centralized and user management can be performed
from a single interface, without logging in to the TS4500 tape library. (This capability was
referred to as the Storage Authentication Service (SAS) with the TS3500 tape library.) The
default status for remote authentication is Disabled, as shown in Figure 4-31.
Disabled status
With disabled status for remote authentication, users are defined on the local library and the
library uses local authentication to manage the access.
Enabled status
With remote authentication enabled, the users are defined on the remote library and
authentication requests are passed to a remote authentication server (LDAP) that verifies the
user’s name and password. For more information about user setup, see 4.4.1, “Users” on
page 224.
The optional Transport Layer Security (TLS) certificate is purchased from a certifying entity.
The TLS certificate is a plain text file that contains information about the web server. The TLS
certificate verifies that it is indeed what it claims to be. (In this case, the web server is the
TS4500 tape library.) The TLS certificate that is stored on the TS4500 tape library enables
your web browser to access the TS4500 tape library without challenging its validity. The
credential is the LDAP equivalent to a password.
Kerberos
Kerberos is a network authentication protocol that is based on symmetric key cryptography.
Kerberos assigns a unique key, which is called a ticket, to each user who logs on to the
network. The ticket is embedded in messages that are sent over the network. The receiver of
a message uses the ticket to authenticate the sender.
The Service keytab must be stored on the TS4500 tape library. It is used as part of the
authentication process to verify which user is connecting to it. A Service keytab that is stored
on the TS4500 tape library enables automated authentication.
Each custom role has unique access permissions. For more information about custom roles,
see 4.4.2, “Roles” on page 230.
Kerberos
If you selected the Kerberos authentication method, the Kerberos Settings window opens
(see Figure 4-34).
LDAP
If LDAP is selected, the LDAP Settings window opens, as shown in Figure 4-36. Complete the
required fields in this frame.
Note: The LDAP settings are tested when you select Next. If the settings are correct and
communication works, a green check mark appears next to the LDAP repository URI.
Then, continue with the next setting. If the LDAP URl is not setup or no connection exists,
or if a setup cannot be done, a red cross (+) appears next to the URl.
Figure 4-38 shows an example of a completed Simple lookup method page that includes an
example of the format of the required fields.
The Advanced search option provides more flexible searching and better performance. The
Advanced search lookup method has the following search fields, required to be complete:
Base DN: Allows you to customize the Base Distinguished name to begin the
LDAP search, which begins the search deeper in the LDAP tree for
better performance.
Group name Allows you to choose what attribute in the LDAP group accounts is
used to associate with a TS4500 role.
User name Allows you to customize which attribute in the LDAP user account is
used for user names.
Group Member Allows you to customize the link between the LDAP users and groups.
The following fields are optional when selecting Advanced search and are used to improve
LDAP search performance:
User name filter
Group name filter
After entering the settings, click Next to continue to test the settings are correct and to
confirm access to the servers. In the Confirm Access page, for the Remote UID field, add a
user that was created inside the LDAP server. If all settings are correct, remote authentication
is enabled and logs all users out of the management GUI.
If the default password and session policy settings are not strict enough for your company’s
rules, you can customize the settings on the Password and Session Policy window by
selecting Modify.
A preset local user that is called localGUI, with the role of monitor, is enabled by default with
the TS4500 tape library. This default allows a local user to access the integrated management
console (IMC) without logging in.
However, if your company policies and procedures prohibit this type of quick access to the
System Summary view, you can disable this local user login function. To disable the user login
function, select Settings → Security → Password and Session Policy, and set the
Automatic IMC (local GUI) login at power on setting so that a password is required.
The TS4500 tape library is secured with a Secure Sockets Layer (SSL). SSL is a protocol for
encrypted (secure) transmission through the internet.
Use the Secure Communications page to configure the SSL settings (see Figure 4-42).
Use the Secure Communications window to enable or disable SSL or to update a certificate.
Selecting Enable or Update provides the option to upload an SSL web certificate. This
window also displays the type of certificate that is used and the upload date and expiration
date.
SSL is a cryptographic security system that uses the following keys to encrypt data:
A public key that is known to everyone
A private key that is known only to the recipient of the message
Many websites use this protocol to obtain confidential user information, such as credit card
numbers. By convention, URLs that require an SSL connection start with https instead of
http. HTTPS stands for Hypertext Transfer Protocol Secure.
The following options are available when you enable secure communications or update a
certificate:
System-defined
The SSL cipher specification list system value is read-only. Its values are automatically
modified to contain the list of cipher suites that are supported by the system SSL. If you
use this option, the SSL cipher specification list system value is automatically updated
with new cipher suite capabilities when you install or upgrade to a future release of the
firmware system.
User-defined
If a certificate exists, its identifying information is displayed in the Certificate field. You can
use this certificate, or click the folder icon to upload another certificate.
Note: If you modify a certificate that was uploaded, you must re-select the PEM file by
clicking the folder icon and specifying the file, even if the name is still displayed in the
Certificate field. If the certificate is encrypted, you must re-enter the password.
From the Add Server tab, add each encryption key server to use on the logical libraries
configuration of this TS4500, as shown in Figure 4-43. This action makes the IP address of
the server available when you set up library-managed encryption on the logical library.
Encryption is managed at the logical library level. All encryption-enabled drives that are
assigned to a logical library use the same method of encryption. For more information about
methods of encryption, see 4.7.2, “Create Logical Library window” on page 280 and
Chapter 3, “Encryption” on page 173.
The Add Encryption Key Server window requires you to first check with an Internet Control
Message Protocol (ICMP) ping to ensure that the server is available when you add the server.
Click Ping (see Figure 4-43) when you add a server to the list. Encryption key servers can
also be added when you modify a logical library.
Note: The TS4500 supports the configuration of four encryption key servers for each
logical library.
Run Diagnostics
If you want to verify the functionality of all of the network-attached devices, you can run
diagnostics on the devices. Select Actions → Run Diagnostics. Then, select the drive or
select drive to test and select Run Diagnostics.
Note: When you use the Run Diagnostics function, a warning icon might appear in the
Ethernet column if you disabled Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) requests.
At least one key server IP address must be selected for the Run Diagnostics option to
display on the Actions menu (or the right-click drop-down menu). If no key server
IP address is added (or selected), the Run Diagnostics option does not display on the
Actions menu. This server must be configured on a logical library for diagnostics to run.
ICMP requests
Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) is a messaging protocol (external to the TS4500
tape library) that sends error messages that a requested service is not available or that one of
the network-attached devices cannot be reached. ICMP requests are disabled or enabled on
the server on which the IBM Security Key Lifecycle Manager runs.
The disabled status of ICMP requests can trigger a warning in the Ethernet column when the
Run Diagnostics function starts.
When the Encryption Internal Label option is configured, the encryption-enabled tape drive
automatically derives the encryption policy and key information from the metadata that is
written on the tape volume by the TS4500 tape library. Mapping the cartridge key labels to the
key-encrypting labels enables the TS4500 tape library to apply the same encryption policy for
both types of labels. The Encryption Internal Label is a way for the system to share encryption
policies.
For a TS4500 with only a single drive type that is installed, either Linear Tape-Open (LTO) or
3592, only one option is shown on the Security page, as shown in Figure 4-45.
Encryption is managed at the logical library level. All encryption-enabled drives that are
assigned to a logical library use the same method of encryption. For more information about
methods of encryption, see 4.7.2, “Create Logical Library window” on page 280 and
Chapter 3, “Encryption” on page 173.
The examples that are shown in the next sections show the display for a mixed drive type
library.
The following values are available for the “Map to key mode” field:
Direct-Default Set: The map to label is determined from the encryption key manager. The
label was configured at the encryption key manager, and the key label field is left blank.
(This option is for LTO cartridges only.)
Direct-Specific: The specified key label references a symmetric data key. (This option is for
LTO cartridges only.)
You can turn off the animation if the enlarged icons obscure any information in the window.
Also, turning off the navigation animation helps increase performance when you are remotely
connecting to the TS4500 over a slow network connection. Figure 4-49 shows example of
animation disabled.
Note: The options and actions under the Access icon are available only to users with the
administrator role.
4.4.1 Users
Administrators can create and manage users, map users to a role, and view which users have
active sessions and how many connections they have from the Users page.
Note: With the TS4500 tape library, password protection is always enabled and all users
are required to sign in with a user name and password.
Selecting Users from the Access menu gives an overview of all configured users, as shown in
Figure 4-51.
2 Name of user
3 Actions tab
8 User role
The actions that are available from the Users page differ, depending on whether the library is
configured for local or remote authentication. Table 4-5 lists the available actions.
Create User X
Map To Role X
Modify Email X
Reset Password X
Delete User X
Disconnect X X
Connections X X
Properties X X
Local authentication
With local authentication, each TS4500 tape library maintains a separate database of user
names with corresponding passwords and roles. Therefore, user management must be
performed on each library.
When local authentication is enabled, the Users page shows all users and their state
(connected or disconnected). The number of active connections is displayed next to the user
state. It is also possible to view and modify email addresses when local authentication is
enabled.
Remote authentication
With remote authentication, security tasks are centralized and user management can be
performed from a single interface, without logging in to the TS4500 tape library. This function
was referred to as the Storage Authentication Service (SAS) with the TS3500 tape library.
Important: The name of the group on the remote authentication server must be the same
as the name of the role on the TS4500 tape library for the group to be matched to that role.
The “create” action is disabled on the Users page when remote authentication is enabled
because you must create the user on the remote authentication server first. In addition,
modifying a user’s email, password, and user group must be performed on the remote
authentication server. Only connected users are shown on the User page, as shown in
Figure 4-51 on page 224.
For more information about enabling remote authentication, see “Enable remote
authentication” on page 209.
A preset local user called localGUI, with the role of monitor, is enabled by default with the
TS4500 tape library. This is the only local user that is valid when remote authentication is
enabled.
If the localGUI user is deleted, all users are required to log in at the IMC.
To disable this local user login function and show the login window at the IMC, click
Settings → Security and then, select Access Rules.
Creating users
You can create up to 80 users, each with a unique user name and password.
Each user account is mapped to a role that defines the pages that the user can view and the
actions that the user can perform. Each user can be mapped to only one role, but multiple
users can be mapped to any role.
For more information about the user roles and how to configure them, see 4.4.2, “Roles” on
page 230.
For more information about creating and managing roles, see 4.4.2, “Roles” on page 230.
A user can receive the temporary password through one of the following methods:
If the Send password to this email option is selected, you must specify a valid email
address for a user so that the user can receive passwords and email notifications. You
must set up email notifications first (for more information, see “Email Server” on
page 204).
When a user is created or when a user’s password is reset, the temporary password is
automatically sent to the email address of the user, rather than to an administrator. A user
with a valid email address can also be selected as a recipient of email alerts from the
Notifications page.
If an email address is not specified, an administrator is responsible for generating a new
password or resetting a password and informing the user.
The password that you set must conform to the rules that are defined on the Password and
Session Policy window. For more information, see “Password and Session Policy” on
page 215.
Important: Because a user’s password expires after the user is created, a new user is
prompted to reset the password the first time that the new user logs in.
After all fields are completed, select Modify to receive a message that confirms that the user
is created and a reminder that the password is only temporary (see Figure 4-53).
First-time login
When a user logs in for the first time, the user is presented with the login window. The user
must enter their username and temporary password to start the login process, as shown in
Figure 4-54.
The user is then presented with the change password window, as shown in Figure 4-55.
The new password must conform to rules defined in the Password and Session Policy. For
more information, see “Password and Session Policy” on page 215.
After the user sets their password, the user logs in with the new password in the initial login
window, as shown in Figure 4-54. After the user logs in with the new password, the user can
access the TS4500 management GUI with access to the assigned role.
If the user lost their password, any administrator can reset the password. If the user is
locked, the administrator must unlock the user first.
Delete: An administrator can delete a user. The user must be in a disconnected state to be
deleted.
Disconnect: An administrator can disconnect a user from the TS4500.
Connections: This option lists the IP addresses that were used by the selected user to log
in to the system. This option shows whether a user is being used multiple times and from
what address.
Locked out
If you are locked out of the TS4500 management GUI, you can revert to the default
administrator user name and password by using the reset button located on the panel near
the pause button of the TS4500 tape library. This button resets the user name and password
to the default logon settings for 15 minutes.
Use this reset button only for emergencies, for example, if the remote authentication server is
down or if the administrator loses or forgets their password and no administrators can access
the system. For more information about this process, see “Access Recovery” on page 50.
4.4.2 Roles
Roles define the pages that users can view and the actions that they can perform. Library
administrators manage roles and the users that are assigned to them. Figure 4-59 shows the
Role window.
Preset roles
The TS4500 tape library has four preset roles, each with a different level of access to the
TS4500 management GUI. It is also possible to create up to 16 roles, each with a custom
name and one of the preset permission levels. All roles have access to all logical libraries.
You cannot rename, delete, or modify the access permissions for any of the preset roles.
Custom roles
Users that are mapped to a role with a customized name can view all of the pages that are
available to the selected preset permission level of the custom role.
Note: The permissions of a custom role with service-level access cannot be modified,
even from the TS4500 CLI.
To remove a role, select the role. Then, click Access → Roles → Actions → Delete. You can
delete a role only if no users are assigned to the role.
You can also use the TS4500 CLI to create, modify, and delete roles, and to customize the
permissions of a role.
Note: You must create a custom role before a user can be assigned to it.
Ensure that the TS4500 CLI is installed. Open a command prompt in the same directory as
the .jar file.
This command is useful to gather current role permissions that you can modify.
viewRolePermissions
The viewRolePermissions command displays a list of all permissions for a specified role. For
example, we set up a role that is called Redbooks, which we want to save to a file that is called
role.txt, as shown in Example 4-1.
The output of this command is saved to our file, role.txt. You can now modify this file and
change roles to suit your requirements. The output from this command can also be copied to
another text file and modified.
To confirm that the role is changed, run the viewRolePermissions command, as shown in
Example 4-3.
For more information about the TS4500, see Chapter 5, “Command-line interface” on
page 319.
4.5.1 Cartridges
Use the Cartridges page to move cartridges to a different location, remove cartridges to an
I/O station, assign cartridges to a logical library, or unassign cartridges from a logical library.
Search for specific cartridges by using the filter. Click Filter and enter a value in the search
field or click the Advanced Filter icon to the right of the search field to enter extended search
criteria, as shown in Figure 4-63. Enter substrings if the entire value is unknown. Wildcard
characters are not supported. Instead of wildcard characters, you can add substrings to the
search by clicking the plus sign (+) at the end of each criterion. (Search values are not
case-sensitive.)
This option is used to view how many cleanings remain on a cleaning cartridge. The number
of remaining cleanings is displayed in the Cleans Remaining column of the Cartridges table.
This column is hidden, by default.
Right-click the table header to select the Cleans Remaining column. To see all cleaning
media in the TS4500, sort the column by Cleans Remaining by using the arrow, as shown in
Figure 4-65.
You can also view how many cleaning cycles remain on all cleaning cartridges in a logical
library on the Cartridges by Logical Library page.
You can optionally eject expired cleaning cartridges automatically. For more information about
enabling this feature, see “Cartridges and Accessors” on page 192.
The assignment is then determined by the first application to import the cartridge. VOLSER
ranges were called the Cartridge Assignment Policy with the TS3500 tape library.
You can modify the cartridges that are assigned to a logical library by modifying the VOLSER
range of the logical library from the VOLSER Ranges by Logical Library page.
Assigning a cartridge
If an individual cartridge is outside of a VOLSER range, you can use the Assign action to
assign that cartridge to a specific logical library. However, creating VOLSER ranges is the
preferred method for assigning cartridges to logical libraries.
You can bulk assign all available or unassigned cartridges from the Cartridges by Logical
Library page by highlighting the Available or Unassigned cartridge rows and selecting
Actions → Assign All Cartridges.
Note: If the new cartridge assignments exceed the maximum number of cartridges that is
allowed by a logical library, any other cartridges are unassigned. Go to the Logical
Libraries page to modify the maximum number of cartridges that is allowed, and then
attempt to assign the cartridge again.
If a tape has an unknown VOLSER, select Actions → Fix Unknown VOLSER to apply a new
VOLSER number to the tape. Enter the first six characters of the volume serial number and
then, add the last two characters that specify the cartridge type, taking note of the warning
message, as shown in Figure 4-68.
LTO media L8, LY, L7, LX, L6, LW, L5, LV, L4, LU, L3, and LT
3592 media JE, JV, JM, JD, JZ, JL, JC, JY, JB, JX, and JK
Moving cartridges
At times, you might want to instruct the library to move a specific tape cartridge. For example,
if a single host controls the library and the host fails during an operation, you can use the
Actions menu on the Cartridges page to move one or more cartridges to continue the
operation, as shown in Figure 4-70.
You can select Actions → Move → To Drive, Actions → Move → To Slot, or Actions →
Move → To I/O Slot, depending on where you want to move the cartridge.
Note: The use of the Cartridges page to move cartridges might result in synchronization
problems with the application. To avoid this scenario, the preferred method is to use the
application to move cartridges.
The file name includes the date that the file was downloaded and the library name
(LIBNAME_YYYYMMDD_mount_history.csv).
Search for specific cartridges by using the filter. Select Filter and enter a value in the search
field. Enter substrings if the entire value is unknown. Wildcard characters are not supported.
Instead of wildcard characters, you can add more substrings to the search by clicking the plus
sign (+) icon at the end of each criterion. Search values are not case-sensitive.
You can optionally automatically eject expired cleaning cartridges. To enable this feature,
select Settings → Library → Cartridges, and then, select Automatically, as shown in
Figure 4-12 on page 192.
If the VOLSER of a newly inserted cartridge does not match the VOLSER range of a logical
library, the cartridge is available to import into any logical library of the same media type. The
assignment is then determined by the first application to import the cartridge.
You can modify the cartridges that are assigned to a logical library by modifying the VOLSER
range of the logical library from the VOLSER Ranges by Logical Library page.
Assigning
If an individual cartridge is outside of a defined VOLSER range, you can use the Assign
action to assign that cartridge to a specific logical library. However, creating VOLSER ranges
is the preferred method for assigning cartridges to logical libraries.
Note: If the new cartridge assignments exceed the maximum number of cartridges that is
allowed by a logical library, any other cartridges are unassigned. Go to the Logical
Libraries page to modify the maximum number of cartridges that is allowed and try the
cartridge assignment again.
Unassigning cartridges
Select Actions → Unassign to unassign one or more cartridges, as shown in Figure 4-75.
However, this action might result in synchronization problems with the application. To avoid
this scenario, the preferred method is to use the application to eject cartridges.
Depending on where you want to move the cartridge, choose one of the following options:
Actions → Move → To Drive
Actions → Move → To Slot
Actions → Move → To I/O Slot
Note: The use of the Cartridges page to move cartridges might result in synchronization
problems with the application. To avoid this scenario, the preferred method is to use the
application to move cartridges.
When you insert a cartridge into the library and its VOLSER is within a range that is assigned
to a certain logical library, the cartridge is assigned to that logical library automatically. The
cartridge must be of the same media type as that logical library. For example, if you create a
logical library that is called LogicalLibrary1 for VOLSERs that range from ABC000 to ABC999
(a library of LTO drives) and then you insert a cartridge with VOLSER ABC123, the library
recognizes that the VOLSER belongs in the range and assigns it to LogicalLibrary1.
If you insert a cartridge that is outside of any VOLSER ranges, it is available to import into any
logical library of the same media type. The assignment is then determined by the first
application to import the cartridge.
Within a physical TS4500 tape library, a maximum of 300 VOLSER ranges can be created
among all logical libraries.
Note: Any action that causes cartridge assignments to change can result in application
synchronization problems. To avoid this scenario, first use the application to eject any
cartridges that are assigned to the selected VOLSER range.
If you insert a cartridge that is outside of any VOLSER ranges, it is available to import into any
logical library of the same media type. The assignment is then determined by the first
application to import the cartridge.
Within a physical TS4500 tape library, a maximum of 300 VOLSER ranges can be created
among all logical libraries.
Note: Any action that causes cartridge assignments to change can result in application
synchronization problems. To avoid this scenario, first use the application to eject any
cartridges that are assigned to the selected VOLSER range.
4.6.1 Drives
Use the Drives page to view the location and state of all drives in the library, and to enable or
disable control paths, eject cartridges, reset or clean drives, or update drive firmware.
You can use the view options and display additional drive status options on the Drives page,
such as port status, drive serial numbers (S/Ns), and worldwide node name (WWNN), as
shown in Figure 4-82 on page 253.
The Drives page and the Actions menu options are shown on Figure 4-83. Depending on
whether the selected drive is assigned or unassigned, you optionally can reassign or assign
the drive.
You assign a drive by using the Assign option, which is the same as reassigning the drive.
Unassigning a drive
Before a drive is physically removed from the tape library, it must be empty and unassigned.
Use the Drives page to eject the cartridge and use the Drives by Logical Library page to
unassign the drive, as shown in Figure 4-85.
Use this feature to verify any media for the ability to read all of the data on the selected media
within a logical library. Media verification is set up to run automatically on a set schedule.
You can set a recurring schedule for verification by days, months, or years. After you set up
the media verification, you can verify a single medium before the set schedule, if required.
Cartridges that are being verified are still available to use. If the library receives a request for
information about a cartridge that is being verified, the verification is suspended and the
cartridge is released to fill the request. When the cartridge is no longer needed, verification is
resumed.
Media verification requires that you configure dedicated drives in the logical library for this
function. We recommend that you dedicate at least two drives for this task. These drives are
not available to use for media access, and they are not visible to hosts.
Important: Assigning drives within a logical library as media verification drives is disruptive
because these drives are taken offline to any application that configured them.
For a library with multiple logical libraries, these drives can be reassigned to a different logical
library to use for media verification, but this reassignment can remove the logical library
verification setup.
After media verification is enabled on a logical library for the first time, all cartridges are due
for verification on the same date, but because the policy period is not a deadline, it merely
establishes a queue of media verification activity. The initial queue of media verification can
take time, even months if a library is large.
This time depends on the number of cartridges, how full they are, and the number of media
verification drives. Each cartridge has a unique last verification date, which means that all
cartridges are not due for media verification at the same time.
Note: We recommend that at least two drives are assigned for verification. The number of
drives needs to be sized based on the number of cartridges in the logical library and how
full they are.
After you run media verification on a cartridge, the next verification is based on the last
verification date, plus the configured policy period of the logical library.
Note: The last verification date is stored in the cartridge memory (CM) so that the policy is
still applied even if a cartridge is exported and imported to the same or a different logical
library (LL). The policy period is based on the logical library settings of the logical library to
which the cartridge is imported.
A warning message appears to inform you that this drive will not be available for media
access and it will not be visible to hosts. This drive can be used for media verification only, as
shown in Figure 4-86. Repeat this task for all drives that you configure for media verification.
After all of the required drives are set, the drives display as verification drives, as shown in
Figure 4-87.
These drives are now assigned to the required logical library. They can be seen from the
Drives by Logical Library menu, as shown in Figure 4-89.
Figure 4-89 Verify media drives that are assigned to a logical library
From the pop-up menu, enable Automatic media verification and select the frequency, first
verification date, and media verification drive options to suit your requirements. You can set a
recurring schedule for verification by days, months, or years.
You can select the date to start the first verification, and you can set the verification drives, as
shown in Figure 4-91.
This action enables media verification for the selected logical library. The verification occurs
based on the policy that you set.
This selection places this tape volume next in the queue for verification. By using the Tasks
menu, you can monitor and display the status of the media verification, as shown in
Figure 4-93.
Also, you can use the Cartridges menu to obtain the last verification date by clicking Export
Table Data to export the table data to a spreadsheet, as shown in Figure 4-95.
Any drives that are enabled as control paths are identified with the icon that is shown in
Figure 4-97.
To enable a control path, select the drive or drives that are to be configured, then select
Actions → Enable Control Path to designate one or more drives as control path drives, as
shown in Figure 4-98 on page 262.
It is possible for a logical library to have no control path drives. To disable a control path, use
the same method that is shown in Figure 4-98, but select Actions → Disable Control Path,
as shown in Figure 4-99.
The use of multiple control paths for any single, a configured logical library provides the
following benefits:
Allows access to the logical library by multiple servers
Provides communication failover so that if one control path fails, host communication for
the entire library is not lost
Note: Use the Path Failover feature (Feature Code 1682) to enable the host device driver
to send a command again to an alternate control path in the same logical library.
Configuration of Path Failover is performed in the host device driver.
Access to the logical library is on a first-come, first-served basis. Each control path for a
logical library can accept commands while the library is in use by another control path.
Control path drives cannot be removed from a logical library that is performing jobs. If the
logical library is not actively in use, control path drives can be removed from a logical library
only after all non-control path drives are removed or a different control path drive is assigned.
In this window, you can modify or add fields, including the following examples:
Modify the iSCSI name for this drive. This name is unique, such as an iSCSI qualified
name (IQN) for each drive. The target iSCSI name has a maximum of 223 characters and
has a default of naa,driveWWNN.
Modify the iSCSI alias, which is a name that is given to the drive and associated to the
iSCSI name. It is used to give a user-defined name to the drive, such as library serial
number and drive position. This field makes managing the drive easier.
DHCP or static IP address can be used. If DHCP is used, the IP address does not need to
be added.
Static IP address, gateway, and network mask can be added for each drive, or for a range
of drives.
To configure all drives IP address information at the same time, select all of the drives that are
to be configured; then, select Actions → Modify iSCSI. The window that is shown in
Figure 4-101 opens. Here, you can enter the starting IP address for the drive port and all
drives are configured starting at this address.
To display the current drive settings, select the drive then, Actions → Properties. The
current drive settings and properties are displayed, as shown in Figure 4-102.
A valid cleaning cartridge is required for cleaning drives. Monitor cleaning cartridge usage
from the Cartridges page. For more information, see “Viewing cleaning cartridge status” on
page 245.
You can update drive firmware on one drive or multiple drives at one time. Any drives that are
selected on the Drives page are updated with the firmware level that was uploaded. It is
possible to install firmware levels that are earlier than the version that the drive is running.
To avoid disrupting the host, control path drives are updated when they are reset. All other
drives are updated when the drive is unloaded. Control path drives must be manually reset to
use the uploaded firmware level.
The drive firmware package for your workstation is available from IBM Fix Central:
http://www.ibm.com/support/fixcentral/
Note: The LTO 8, 7, 6, and 5 drive firmware image file is named LTOZ_xxxx.fcp_fh.ro
where Z is the drive type and xxxx is the firmware level. The TS1100 drive firmware image
file is named xxxx_xxx.fcp_fj_D.fmrz where xxxx_xxx is the drive firmware level.
Monitor the status of the update in the State column and the Firmware column of the Drives
table.
Select the control path drives with a state of “Reset Required” and select Actions → Reset to
reset the drives.
When you export drive usage statistics, a LIBNAME_YYYYMMDD_drive_statistics.csv file for all
of the drives is exported. This file presents the number of loads, number of megabytes read
and written, and number of cleanings for each drive location.
You can use this window to export service logs from a drive to send to IBM Support, if
needed. Select the drive for which you want to export the logs, and then, select Export
Service Logs from the Export Data menu.
The bar turns red if all of the drives in the logical library are being used. If all of the drives are
being used frequently, the logical library might be over-allocated and you need to consider
adding drives to the logical library.
The selection of the Ports option on the Drives menu opens a summary page of all drives and
their port status, as shown in Figure 4-109.
The port State column is sorted by state color (green, yellow, or gray).
The gray port status icon indicates that no light is detected at the drive’s Fibre Channel port.
One of the following conditions is true:
A Fibre Channel cable is unplugged at the drive or at the nearest Fibre Channel device
(host bus adapter, switch, or hub).
A Fibre Channel cable is broken between the drive and the nearest Fibre Channel device
(host bus adapter, switch, or hub).
The drive or the nearest Fibre Channel device (host bus adapter, switch, or hub) is
powered off or has a hardware problem.
The yellow port status icon indicates that the Fibre Channel connections between the drive
and the Fibre Channel device (host bus adapter, switch, or hub) to which it is connected are
good and port is logged into fabric. However, communication is not established to the host
application, which is caused by the application that has an offline drive.
The green port status icon indicates that the Fibre Channel connections are good and
communication is established.
The summary display shows the Speed and Topology columns, which include both the setting
and the actual value in the following format: setting (actual).
To modify a port setting, select the port or ports that you want to modify and select Actions →
Modify Speed or Modify Topology from the Ports view, as shown in Figure 4-113.
Figure 4-113 Modifying the topology and speed in the Ports view
The following setting values are valid for the port link speed:
Auto
1 Gbps
2 Gbps
4 Gbps
8 Gbps
16 Gbps for TS1160 drive only
From the Actions menu, you can display the properties of a port, as shown in Figure 4-114.
The port State column is sorted by state color (green, yellow, or gray).
The gray port status icon indicates that no light is detected at the drive’s Ethernet port. One of
the following conditions is true:
A Ethernet cable is unplugged at the drive or at the nearest Ethernet device (host bus
adapter, switch, or hub).
A Ethernet cable is broken between the drive and the nearest Ethernet device (host bus
adapter, switch, or hub).
The green port status icon indicates that the Ethernet connections are good and
communication is established.
The summary display shows information about all of the Ethernet drives, such as state, IP
address, iSCSI details, MAC address and speed of connection.
From the Actions menu, you can display the properties of a port, as shown in Figure 4-120.
Note: The Slots option is only available if the user logged in by using the service user ID or
if the user has service-level access.
The TS4500 tape library includes ALMS, so you can immediately start to assign tape drives to
any logical library by using the TS4500 management GUI. Logical libraries can also be
added, deleted, or easily changed without disruption. Storage capacity can be changed
without affecting host applications.
ALMS offers the dynamic management of cartridges, cartridge storage slots, tape drives, and
logical libraries. It enables the TS4500 tape library to achieve unprecedented levels of
integration for functionality through dynamic partitioning, storage slot pooling, and flexible
drive assignment.
ALMS eliminates downtime when you add capacity on demand (CoD) or high-density
capacity on demand (HD CoD) storage, add or remove logical libraries, or change logical
library storage allocation. ALMS also reduces downtime when you add expansion frames,
add or remove tape drives, or change the logical drive allocation.
The TS4500 tape library complies with the SCSI Medium Changer standard. ALMS is not
apparent to the application. The SCSI Medium Changer can be thought of as a
“location-centric” interface.
Functional description
The ALMS features are described in this section.
An element address is associated with a storage slot that is selected by the library, as
cartridges are moved and inventoried. If a storage element is empty because of a move, that
source element address becomes unsolicited. The association of storage element addresses
occurs in a way that is transparent to the application software.
You can select the number of storage element addresses for a logical library (as reported to
the host application software) by changing the Maximum Number of Cartridges setting for that
logical library with the TS4500 management GUI. For each logical library, the default value for
this setting is the number of addressable storage slots that is installed in the library for that
cartridge type when ALMS is first enabled or after ALMS is enabled when the logical library
is created.
Note: You can change the Maximum Number of Cartridges setting for each logical library,
but the value must always be greater than or equal to the number of cartridges that is
assigned to that logical library. The Maximum Number of Cartridges can be set to a value
that is higher than the number of addressable storage slots that is installed at the time to
allow future library capacity expansion to not be apparent to the host application software.
However, application performance might degrade slightly because of the greater number of
addresses. Be careful to not exceed the license limitations of the host application software.
Drive assignment
By using the ALMS flexible drive assignment capability, any drive in any position within any
frame can be assigned to any logical library without creating any gaps in drive addresses.
Drive (data transfer) element addresses are still mapped to specific drive locations when the
drive is assigned. Any drive location can be assigned to any logical library by using the
TS4500 management GUI. Each drive that is added to a logical library is assigned to the
lowest available element address, regardless of the drive location.
Note: The intermix of models is supported within the same logical library, but only for
drives of the same type. LTO drives cannot be mixed with 3592 drives, and 3592 drives
cannot be mixed with LTO drives.
ALMS is enabled by default on the TS4500, and the data terminal equipment (DTE)
addresses for any newly installed and assigned drives do not depend on the positions of the
drives. The DTE address for any newly installed or assigned drive is determined by the
sequence in which the drive is assigned to each logical library. With ALMS, drives are
assigned to logical libraries by using the Drives by Logical Library page to assign a tape drive
to a logical library on the Management Interface (MI).
When a drive is unassigned from a logical library by using the web interface, only that DTE
address is made available for future usage. No other DTE addresses are affected.
The minimum logical library has a name only and it can be thought of as a file folder that has
no contents. Drives are assigned to the logical library from the Drives page of the TS4500
management GUI. Cartridges are assigned to the logical library based on their VOLSERs and
by using one of the following methods, which are listed in priority order:
VOLSER ranges
Software application moves from the I/O station (based on the source application that
issued the command)
Manual assignment by an operator by using the TS4500 management GUI
The primary and backup copies of the VOLSER assignment and physical location of
cartridges are stored in nonvolatile random access memory (NVRAM).
All cartridge assignments are displayed on the VOLSER range bar. As you create logical
libraries and assign VOLSER ranges, any cartridges that are not part of those ranges remain
unassigned. View or assign unassigned cartridges on the Cartridges page.
When you insert a cartridge into the library and its VOLSER is within a range that is assigned
to a certain logical library, the cartridge is assigned to that logical library. The cartridge must
be of the same media type as that logical library. For example, if you create Logical
Library 1 for VOLSERs that range from ABC000 to ABC999 (a library of LTO drives) and then
you insert a cartridge with VOLSER ABC123, the library recognizes that VOLSER as belonging
to the range and assigns it to Logical Library 1.
If you insert a cartridge that is outside of any VOLSER ranges, it is available to import into any
logical library of the same media type. The assignment is then determined by the first
application to import the cartridge.
You can view all of the VOLSER ranges if you select Actions → View VOLSER ranges. You
can also view all VOLSER ranges that are assigned to each logical library on the VOLSER
Ranges by Logical Library page.
Virtual I/O
With ALMS, virtual I/O slots enhance the import and export capabilities of the library. With the
TS4500 tape library, virtual I/O slots are always enabled so that the library automatically
queues all cartridge moves between the I/O station and the storage slots. This capability
makes the process of adding and removing cartridges easier and faster.
The TS4500 tape library has I/O stations with cartridge magazines so that you can import and
export up to 144 cartridges at any time. The I/O slots are also known as import/export
elements (IEEs). Virtual I/O slots increase the quantity of available I/O slots by allowing
storage slots to appear to the host as I/O slots. These storage slots are also called virtual
import/export elements (VIEEs).
With virtual I/O slots, the library automatically moves cartridges from the I/O stations to the
storage slots, enhancing import and export performance, while also decoupling physical
cartridge movement from the application, increasing operator efficiency.
With virtual I/O slots, the library has various mechanisms for selecting the best storage slot
location for each inserted cartridge, and the best I/O station for each ejected cartridge. These
mechanisms vary depending on the configuration of your library.
The VIEE temporarily takes on the attributes of an IEE until a host moves the cartridge into a
storage element (StE). When the host move occurs, if the cartridge is in a storage slot, no
physical move is needed and the element changes from a VIEE to an StE. Similarly, when a
host exports a cartridge from an StE, the physical storage slot is reported as a VIEE without
moving the cartridge to the I/O station. The library monitors when free space is available in
the I/O station and moves exported cartridges when it is convenient for the library.
The guided setup for the TS4500 tape library allows a single application to operate the library.
However, often it is advantageous to be able to share a single library between heterogeneous
or homogeneous applications. Certain applications (and certain servers) do not allow sharing
a library between systems.
With the TS4500 tape library, you can create configurations that enable the library to process
commands from multiple heterogeneous applications, such as an IBM System p application
and a Windows application. With the TS4500 tape library, you can also create configurations
that enable the library to process commands from multiple homogeneous applications, for
example, the same application that is run by several System p servers.
Configure any single logical library (including the entire physical library) so that it is shared by
two or more servers that are running the same application. Depending on the capabilities of
the server and application, several ways exist to set up this type of configuration. The
following methods are typical examples:
One server to a single control path
All servers to a single control path
Multiple servers through multiple control paths
You can create multiple logical libraries by partitioning the library’s tape drives and tape
cartridges into two or more logical libraries. Each logical library consists of the following
components:
Tape drives
Tape cartridges in storage slots
Tape cartridges in input/output (I/O) slots
Each logical library has its own control path. A control path is a logical path into the library
through which a server sends standard SCSI Medium Changer commands to control the
logical library. For frames that contain LTO tape drives and frames that contain 3592 tape
drives, each logical library control path is available to servers through logical unit number
(LUN) 1 of the first drive that is defined within that logical library. A LUN is a number that is
used by a server to identify a drive.
In a TS4500 tape library, a logical library shares empty storage slots, empty I/O slots, and the
cartridge accessor on a first-come, first-served basis.
Note: When you name logical libraries, develop an enterprise-wide standard or convention
for naming libraries for easier management of the libraries.
With automatic cleaning, cleaning cartridges are shared among logical libraries, so any
appropriate cleaning cartridge is used to clean a drive in any configured logical library.
You can create multiple logical libraries by partitioning the physical library’s tape drives and
tape cartridges into two or more logical libraries. Each logical library can contain only one
media type.
Spectrum Protect
Use this option if you manage your library with Spectrum Protect.
When you select this option, 2 - 4 of the drives that are assigned to the logical library are
designated as control path drives. When possible, two consecutive drives are assigned as
control paths in two separate frames. This selection configures all unassigned drives to this
logical library.
To configure a logical library by using the Spectrum Protect option, select the Spectrum
Protect icon, then define a name, select the media drive type (LTO or 3592), and select the
encryption method to use. If necessary, enter the VOLSER range to use with this logical
library in the Identifier field, and select Create, as shown in Figure 4-129 on page 282.
If library-managed encryption is used, the key server can be set up in the security option that
is described in “Encryption key servers” on page 219. Also, the key server can be added by
using the Modify Encryption Method option from the Actions menu, as described in “Modify
Encryption Method” on page 289.
To change drive assignments or control paths, see 4.6.1, “Drives” on page 252.
When you select this option, 2 - 4 of the drives that are assigned to the logical library are
designated as control path drives. When possible, two consecutive drives are assigned as
control paths in two separate frames. This selection configures all unassigned drives to this
logical library.
If library-managed encryption is used, the key server can be set up in the security option that
is described in “Encryption key servers” on page 219. The key server can be added by using
the Modify Encryption Method option from the Actions menu, as described in “Modify
Encryption Method” on page 289.
For more information about changing drive assignments or control paths, see 4.6.1, “Drives”
on page 252.
Note: The TS7700 is only supported by 3592 drive types, and the encryption method must
be set to System managed. The TS7700 must run R4.0 or higher microcode.
General Use
Use the General Use option if you have another application to manage your TS4500 tape
library and you want to use the default options.
When you select this option, one of the drives that is assigned to the logical library is
designated as a control path drive. This selection configures all unassigned drives to this
logical library.
Custom
Use this option for a complete customization when you create a logical library if the presets
do not fit your requirements. Use the Custom option to set library information and select the
drives, VOLSER range, and maximum number of cartridges. Use this option if you are setting
up multiple logical libraries.
2. Use the first window to define a name, select the media drive type (LTO or 3592), and
select the encryption method to use, if required.
3. Use the Drive Assignment page to configure drives for the logical library, as shown in
Figure 4-134. You can select all unassigned drives or select only the drives that you need.
Only the unassigned drives of the type that was selected (LTO or 3592) are displayed.
5. Use the Maximum Cartridges page to set the number of cartridge slots that is assigned to
this logical library. Also, you can use this page to configure the number of slots by using
the system default, as shown in Table 4-136. The system default is the total number of
slots that is licensed in the library.
6. Use the Summary page to display all of your settings, as shown in Figure 4-137.
Drives are assigned to logical libraries when the logical libraries are created. You can modify
the drives that are assigned to a logical library on the Drives by Logical Library page, as
described in “Reassigning a drive” on page 254.
All cartridge assignments are displayed on the VOLSER range bar. As you create logical
libraries and assign VOLSER ranges, any cartridges that are not part of those ranges remain
unassigned. View or assign unassigned cartridges on the Cartridges page, as described in
4.5.1, “Cartridges” on page 235.
When you insert a cartridge into the library and its VOLSER is within a range that is assigned
to a certain logical library, the cartridge is assigned to that logical library. The cartridge must
be the same media type as the media type of that logical library. For example, if you create
Logical Library 1 for VOLSERs that range from ABC000 to ABC999 (a library of LTO drives),
and then you insert a cartridge with VOLSER ABC123, the library recognizes that VOLSER as
belonging to the range and assigns it to Logical Library 1.
If you insert a cartridge that is outside of any VOLSER ranges, the cartridge is available to
import into any logical library of the same media type. The assignment is then determined by
the first application to import the cartridge.
You can view all of the VOLSER ranges by selecting Actions → View VOLSER ranges. You
can also view all VOLSER ranges that are assigned to each logical library on the VOLSER
Ranges by Logical Library page, as described in 4.5.2, “Cartridges by Logical Library” on
page 244.
Rename
Use the Rename option in the Actions menu to rename a logical library.
Select the logical library. Click Actions → Rename. The Rename window opens and you can
enter a new logical library name.
Select the logical library and click Actions → Modify Maximum Cartridges. The Modify
Maximum Cartridges window opens and you can modify the number of cartridge slots for the
logical library. If you added a storage frame, you can also use the Reset to system default
option, which automatically enters the full licensed capacity of all slots in the physical library.
Select the logical library, and click Actions → Modify Encryption Method. The Modify
Encryption Method window opens so that you can set up or remove encryption from the
logical library. With library-managed encryption, you can use the Modify Encryption Method
page to set the EKM server IP address to use on this logical library. A drop-down list shows all
of the configured EKM servers.
Cartridges are reassigned to existing logical libraries. If the maximum number of cartridges is
met for a logical library, any other cartridges that were assigned to that logical library are
unassigned.
This option removes all paths on the selected logical library to the TS4500 for the time that it
takes to reset the control path drives.
Delete
Use the Delete option on the Actions menu to delete the logical library.
Properties
Click Actions → Properties to display detailed properties about the selected logical library,
as shown in Figure 4-140.
4.7.3 Slots
The Slots option is available for a user with service-level access. Use the Slots option to set
storage slots online or offline.
This option is normally used by the IBM service support representative (SSR) for setting slots
offline and then online during a service action. This option can also be used to set any slot
online and offline for problem determination.
Single or multiple slots can be selected and the number that was selected is displayed in the
upper-right corner of the menu.
4.8 Monitoring
The TS4500 management GUI pages under the Monitoring icon can help you to monitor the
system, events, and tasks, as shown in Figure 4-142.
Hover over the top of a frame, or over an I/O station, to view its state and contents, as shown
in Figure 4-144.
If a problem occurs with any of the components, a warning or error icon is displayed. Hover
over the icon to see a message about the affected component that includes the amount of
time that passed since the event occurred and a short description of the event. Go to the
Events page to view the detailed information about the error or warning.
Library frame
An error or a warning icon at the base of a library frame indicates a problem with the frame
door, I/O station (if applicable), or with any of the slots, cartridges, or drives in that frame.
Cartridge accessor
An error or a warning icon on the cartridge accessor indicates a degraded state of operation
for the accessor or an issue with any of the accessor components (gripper, scanner, or
calibration sensor).
I/O station
Click an I/O station to view the I/O station properties, including the state of the I/O station. The
possible states are empty, cartridges in I/O for 60 minutes or more, or a magazine that is
missing for 60 minutes or more. Icons on the door of the library frame also indicate the I/O
station status. Each icon is described next.
An error occurred with a frame, tape drive, cartridge, or accessor. Hover over the
icon to see a list of the most important issues that cause this state. Click any issue
to open the Events Page to see more information.
A warning occurred with a frame, tape drive, cartridge, or accessor. Hover over the
icon to see a list of the most important issues that cause this state. Click any issue
to open the Events page to see more information.
This situation might occur with input operations if a shortage of storage slots exists.
This situation also might occur with output operations if the I/O station is unattended.
View the state of the cartridges, I/O slot (import queued), or I/O slot on the Cartridges
page.
This situation might occur with input operations if a shortage of storage slots exists.
This situation might occur with output operations if the I/O station is unattended.
View the state of the cartridges, I/O slot (import queued), or I/O slot on the Cartridges
page.
Status pods
Status pods at the bottom of the System page show a quick view of the capacity, drive use,
and logical library health status, as shown in Figure 4-146.
The pod is green when the number of cartridges in the library is fewer than the number of
licensed slots.
The pod is yellow when the physical capacity exceeds the capacity use threshold. If this
situation occurs, you can remove cartridges or purchase additional capacity.
The pod is red when the number of cartridges exceeds the number of licensed slots. If this
situation occurs, you must remove cartridges or purchase additional capacity.
The blue pod fills as the number of drives (in use out of the total number of drives in the
library) increases.
If multiple logical libraries exist, a warning icon displays if all of the drives in any logical library
are in use.
You can use certain actions on the System page to perform physical actions on the library
remotely. For example, you can open and close I/O station doors from the I/O station Actions
menu. You can turn on or turn off the beacon light-emitting diode (LED) from the Actions
menu of any frame with an I/O station. You can use the beacon LED to signal remotely to
operators the frame that requires attention or the I/O station that contains a specific cartridge.
For more information, see “I/O stations” on page 38.
Running an inventory
An inventory operation (see Figure 4-148) includes a check to determine whether each
cartridge storage slot in the library is empty or full. It is followed by a scan of the bar code
labels. An inventory can be run on a single library frame or an entire library.
The TS4500 tape library automatically inventories the library. However, certain conditions
necessitate that you manually start an inventory. For example, if an automatic inventory of the
media was inconsistent, you might need to run an inventory to reconcile an inconsistency.
The TS4500 tape library provides two inventory options, as shown in Figure 4-149.
Note: The depth of a cartridge location in a HD slot is known as a tier. Frame drive side
slots are for the cartridges that are immediately accessible in an HD slot (these are Tier 1
cartridges). Behind that is Tier 2, and so on. The maximum tier in an LTO HD slot is Tier 5.
The maximum tier in a 3592 HD slot is Tier 4. The single slots on the door-side of a frame
are referred to as Tier 0 slots.
When no frame is selected, select Inventory from the Actions menu to start an inventory of
the library. When a frame is selected, the Inventory option inventories only that frame.
Right-click any frame and select Actions → Inventory to inventory only that frame.
You can inventory a single frame by selecting it and then clicking Actions → Inventory. If you
do not select a frame, all frames are inventoried.
Typically, the following time frames are required for the TS4500 tape library to audit
cartridges:
Less than 30 seconds for each HD slot
Up to 10 minutes to inventory a column of full HD LTO slots
Up to 8 minutes to inventory a column of full HD 3592 slots
More than 45 minutes to perform a full inventory with an audit on a single HD frame,
depending on the frame type
Reset Library
You can reset the TS4500 tape library control system if the library experiences a stopped
state. This action (see Figure 4-150) resets the node cards in the library.
A reset can take up to 3 minutes. A reset might require you to reconnect to the web server
after the reset completes.
Use the TS4500 tape library to update library firmware without scheduling downtime and
without interrupting the job flow or reducing productivity.
A TS4500 tape library firmware upgrade is generally performed by the IBM service support
representative (SSR) if the update fixes a field issue or if the update is suggested by IBM. For
client-initiated requests, the upgrade is the responsibility of the client. Contact your IBM SSR
with any questions about a specific scenario, who is responsible for the upgrade, and whether
a charge is associated with the upgrade.
Update procedure
Obtain the library firmware package from IBM Support or from IBM Fix Central at the following
website and install the package on your workstation:
http://www.ibm.com/support/fixcentral/
2. On the File Upload window, browse to the library firmware image and click Open, as
shown in Figure 4-154.
Note: The library firmware image file is named TS4500_WXYZ.afwz, where W, X, Y, and Z are
different numbers or letters, depending on the firmware version.
4. The firmware is downloaded to the TS4500 tape library first, and this download can take a
few minutes. Then, the update starts and the Tasks pod, which is at the lower-left corner of
the System page, indicates that the firmware update task is in progress. Monitor the status
of the update from the Tasks page by selecting Monitoring → Tasks, as shown in
Figure 4-156.
5. You lose connection after the firmware is upgraded. Log back in to the TS4500 tape library
and select Actions → Events to display the status of the update.
Note: If the library firmware update stops, nondisruptively reset the library from the System
page by selecting Actions → Reset Library. Then, try the firmware update again.
Note: It is helpful to download this file periodically to compare the library configuration
over time or to retain the configuration for auditing purposes.
4.8.2 Events
Events are informational notices, warning alerts, and error alerts that provide more
information about the library and library components. Use the Events page to view these
events and to monitor their status.
Event categories
Error, warning, and information-only events are displayed on this page. The events are
defined in order of severity.
Error events are the highest priority events, and they require immediate intervention. They are
identified by the error icon (a red circle that contains a white X) in the Events table. Errors
indicate a hardware or communication failure that can impair library operations or damage the
system.
Warning
The warning icon is a yellow triangle that contains an exclamation mark, as shown in
Figure 4-159.
Warning events are the second-highest priority events, and they require attention when time
allows. They are identified by the warning icon (a yellow triangle that contains an exclamation
mark) in the Events table. Warnings indicate a problem that does not pose an immediate
threat, but warnings require resolution to ensure that library operations continue smoothly.
Information
The information icon is a blue balloon that contains the lowercase letter i, as shown in
Figure 4-160.
Informational events are the lowest-priority events, and they do not require corrective action.
They are identified by the information icon (a blue balloon that contains a lowercase letter i) in
the Events table. Information-only events provide information about the library or library
operations, such as the user login and tape movements.
Active events, which are displayed in color in the Events table, are events that are not yet
fixed. Inactive events, which are displayed in gray in the Events table, are events that are
being addressed or events that are fixed. Use the Actions → Mark Inactive option to
manually mark an event as inactive. Events can also be marked as inactive manually by an
IBM SSR.
Only errors and warnings can be marked as inactive. Information-only messages are not
alerts, and they cannot be marked as inactive.
View the status of each event in the State column. For events that require service, the State
column shows when a Call Home is generated, when the Call Home is complete, and when
the service action is complete.
If SNMP traps are enabled, notification messages are also sent to the SNMP server based on
the subscription level (error, warning, or information). Select Notifications from the Settings
page to manage SNMP traps and subscriptions.
Monitoring when tapes are moved, and where they are moved to and from, can be helpful to
view overall library activity. This view can also help you diagnose recurring problems if you
use a filtered view of the Events table to display the most recent actions with any component.
Hover over the Events pod to see the location of the event, the relative time since the event
occurred in days (d.), hours (hr.), and minutes (min.), and a short description of the event.
Monitoring tasks
The Tasks page displays long-running actions, such as inventory and reset, that run in the
background while the library performs other operations. Use this page to monitor the progress
of tasks and to view task properties.
The Tasks table displays all active tasks. They are sorted first by state and second by time.
Tasks are removed from the table after a certain amount of time when they expire.
Highlight a task in the table and select Actions → Properties to view a complete description
of the task and the task history, as shown in Figure 4-165.
Note: If a long-running task stops or appears to take more time than necessary, you can
reset the library and then start the task again. You can nondisruptively reset the library by
selecting Actions → Reset from the System page to reset the library.
TSLM provides a resource management layer between applications, such as IBM Spectrum
Protect, and the tape library hardware. TSLM decouples tape resources from applications.
This capability simplifies the aggregation and sharing of tape resources.
TSLM can combine the capacity of multiple TS4500 and TS3500 libraries into a single
reservoir of tape storage that can be managed from a single point. This capability allows more
effective management, monitoring, and reporting of the use of tape storage resources for new
and existing TS4500 and TS3500 systems.
TSLM is software that is designed to exceed today’s tape storage management challenges for
various clients that are involved in High Performance Computing (HPC) environments, such
as oil and gas exploration and genomic analysis, where dozens of tape libraries and
hundreds of tape drives must be shared and managed to back up and archive petabytes of
data at the lowest cost possible.
The IBM TS4500, IBM TS3500, IBM Tape System Library Manager, and IBM Spectrum
Protect are the ideal solutions for these clients.
For more information about TSLM, see IBM Tape System Library Manager User’s Guide,
GA32-2208:
https://www.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=pub1ga32220803
Optional remote support is available for the TS4500 tape library through its Call Home
capability. The Call Home feature uses the integrated management console (IMC) to report
failures that are detected by the library or a tape drive. Whenever a failure is detected, Call
Home sends detailed error information to IBM Support.
The IBM service support representative (SSR) can then prepare an action plan to handle the
problem before the SSR travels to the library. The library might also periodically send support
information, such as configuration, library, and drive code versions and error logs, to IBM.
The Call Home feature of the TS4500 tape library has three different, but related, capabilities:
Problem Call Home, Heartbeat Call Home, and Test Call Home. The TS4500 tape library
sends data files that might be helpful to IBM Support Center personnel for all three types of
Call Home functions. These data files include library error logs and configuration information,
such as the Machine Reported Product Data (MRPD) log. The MRPD file contains the
following information about the machine (library):
Number of frames and drives
Model and serial number of each frame
Type and serial number of each drive
Code version of the library and each drive
Any machine-detectable features, such as extra I/O stations and capacity expansion
The default method that is used by the library for Call Home support is a broadband
connection that uses the Electronic Customer Care (ECC) Call Home function through the
system console.
To perform an ECC Call Home operation through a system console, the TS4500 tape library
sends Call Home information across a private Ethernet connection to the system console.
The system console then performs the ECC Call Home operation and sends the information
to IBM Remote Technical Assistance Information Network (RETAIN) through the system
console’s modem or Ethernet (broadband) connection.
The IMC is preconfigured for remote support with the TS4500 tape library. The IMC also
comes equipped with a RJ45 port that can be used to connect an external network cable for
remote support.
Table 4-9 lists the capabilities of remote support with a system console.
IBM Call Home database Always available (24x7) access by IBM Support
staff
Error analysis and search capability
The system console also provides optional Ethernet outbound connectivity through the
client’s network to the IBM service support system, RETAIN. All inbound communication over
this connection is restricted. The system console uses the following protocols to port
numbers:
HTTPS: Port 443
HTTP: Port 80
Domain Name System (DNS): Port 53
For outbound and bidirectional data to and from RETAIN, the system console uses the ports
(by default) that are listed in Table 4-10. You can modify the port numbers by using the
TS4500 management GUI.
Table 4-10 Default system console ports for outbound and bidirectional data to and from RETAIN
Port Type of data Direction Protocol
None of the client data that is stored on the tape or in memory for the TS4500 tape library is
transmitted or accessed in a Call Home session. Call Home is enabled or disabled through
the service menu of the TS4500 management GUI. When Call Home is correctly configured,
Call Home uses an IBM Global Services secure network or an internet connection. A unique
account code is used that establishes connections only to RETAIN.
Note: The TS4500 tape library does not support dial-in. Only the IMC/TSSC supports
dial-in.
The system console supports the following data security requirements when the system
console is configured correctly:
Client data, which is stored on tape or in memory, cannot be transmitted or accessed in
remote support sessions.
Remote dial-in is enabled or disabled by the client by using the TS4500 management GUI.
Remote dial-in is disabled, by default. When remote dial-in is enabled, it is enabled for
24 hours, by default.
Remote dial-in requires a password for access. The password is managed by the client.
The default setting for dial-in is to not require a password. A password can be specified by
the client and set by the IBM SSR.
Note: Because the IMC and TSSC both run system console code, all of the TSSC
functions are integrated into the IMC. The security requirements for the IMC are the same
as the security requirements for the TSSC.
Port information communications can be initiated by the tape library or by the host. Typically,
the library initiates a connection only when it is responding to the host. However, in unsolicited
messages, such as statistics notifications and operator interventions, the library initiates a
connection through port 3494. If the library needs to make a connection to the host, the
library chooses a temporary port and uses that port to make an outbound connection to a
3494 listening port on the host.
When the host has a message to deliver to the library, the host chooses its own ephemeral
port by which to make an outbound connection to listening port 3494 on the library manager.
The connection is only maintained for the duration that is required to pass a single message,
and then the connection is disabled.
Table 4-11 lists the minimum level of connectivity that is required to perform library
operations. The following ports can be opened on the firewall, but they are not necessary for
full functionality:
The standard HTTP port, 80, allows inbound communication to the library from the
TS4500 management GUI.
Ports 161 and 162 are the standard ports for sending SNMP traps. SNMP traps can be
sent from the TS4500 tape library or from the IMC. The tape library can be configured to
send traps to SNMP target machines. In this case, the firewall needs to allow outbound
connections from the library from its port 161 to port 162 on the listening SNMP target
machine.
Figure 4-168 External communication connections to the TS4500 tape library control system
The host interface is provided by the drives. The library communicates with the drives through
the Library/Drive Interface. The Ethernet port and modem port do not have any direct access
to the Library/Drive Interface. All communication between the various interfaces is through the
library control system.
All library communication requires explicit support by the library firmware that is running in the
library control system. The library firmware does not provide capability for any of the following
functions:
Answering an incoming call to the modem
Communicating between the Ethernet port and the modem port
Communicating between the Ethernet port and the TS4500 management GUI
Communicating between the TS4500 management GUI and the modem port
Accessing data from tape cartridges through the Library/Drive Interface
Sending or receiving data from tape cartridges through any port
The management GUI does not allow any access to client data, and it does not allow File
Transfer Protocol (FTP) or Telnet type operations. It provides only those functions that are
specifically coded in the library firmware. The only files that it can offload are library logs,
drive logs, and certain usage and error statistics files. It cannot be used to read or write a
client cartridge or otherwise access client data.
The management GUI allows the client to set up an administrator password that is required to
use the management GUI to perform any library task. The management GUI also provides
several levels of access through various preset roles.
These security concerns can be addressed by using the password, user role, and
authentication features that are provided by the management GUI, and also by enabling
SNMP audit logging. When SNMP audit logging is enabled, the library sends notifications
when certain events occur in the library.
For more information about security and firewalls that are used to connect the TS4500 and
IMC to your local network for call home and remote support, see IBM Data Retention
Infrastructure (DRI) System Connectivity and Security:
https://www.ibm.com/support/techdocs/atsmastr.nsf/WebIndex/WP102531
CLI commands instruct the system to perform specific data cartridge management, cleaning
cartridge management, and service-oriented procedures.
Many of the procedures that are started with CLI commands cannot be started through the
TS4500 management GUI.
You can run the CLI from any directory. However, it is simplest to run it from the directory
where the TS4500CLI.jar file is stored. By running the CLI from that directory, you can run the
CLI commands without entering the path name of the TS4500CLI.jar file. However, if you run
the CLI from any other directory, you must include the entire path name of the TS4500CLI.jar
file as a part of the command.
If you run the CLI from the directory where the TS4500CLI.jar file is stored, your command
looks like the following example:
java -jar TS4500CLI.jar -ip [LCC ip] -u [username] -p [password] --[cli_command]
If you run the CLI from any other directory, your command looks like the following example:
java -jar TS4500CLI.jar "C:\[pathname_of_ts4500cli.jar]\TS4500CLI.jar" -ip [LCC
ip] -u [username] -p [password] --[cli_command]
Note: If Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) is enabled on the TS4500 tape library, you must add
the --ssl parameter to the command after the password, as shown in the following
example:
java -jar TS4500CLI.jar -ip [LCC ip] -u [username] -p [password] --ssl
--[CLI_command]
The latest TS4500 CLI information and commands can be found at IBM Knowledge Center:
https://www.ibm.com/support/knowledgecenter/en/STQRQ9/com.ibm.storage.ts4500.doc/t
s4500_cli.html
Note: For Library code R1.5, the CLI version 1.32f or higher is required. The following CLI
command is used to check the version:
java -jar TS4500CLI_forR15_code.jar --version
Note: Some commands require service or an admin user to run. If you see error
****ERROR: User name or password incorrect or password expired, and the user ID and
password are correct, wrong user ID is being used.
This is the list for V1.5 CLI and might differ from previous versions.
Table 5-1 TS4500 CLI commands that are categorized by management function
Management Command usage Command
function
5.3 Commands
The command syntax and examples are described in this section.
If the CLI is run from the directory where the TS4500CLI.jar file is stored, the command looks
like the following example:
java -jar TS4500CLI.jar -ip [LCC ip] -u [username] -p [password] --[cli_command]
If the command is run from any other directory, the command looks like the following example:
java -jar TS4500CLI.jar "C:\[pathname_of_ts4500cli.jar]\TS4500CLI.jar" -ip [LCC
ip] -u [username] -p [password] --[cli_command]
Note: If SSL is enabled in the TS4500 tape library, you must add the --ssl parameter to
the command after the password. Also, the server must have the correct SSL certificates,
as shown in the following example:
java -jar TS4500CLI.jar -ip [LCC ip] -u [username] -p [password] --ssl
--[CLI_command]
assignDataCartridges
Use the assignDataCartridges command to assign or reassign data cartridges to a logical
library.
The assignDataCartridges command receives a text file with one or more assign operations
as input. Each line in the text file is interpreted as an assign operation. In the text file, the data
cartridge location can be specified with the format: [F,C,R,T], where F = frame, C = column,
R = row, and T = tier, as shown in Example 5-2, or the VOLSER, as shown in Example 5-3.
Example 5-4 shows an example of this command using the defined .txt files.
assignDriveToLL
Use the assignDriveToLL command to assign drives to a logical library.
When the assignDriveToLL command runs successfully, the system returns output to the
display, as shown in Example 5-5.
batch
Use the batch command to instruct the system to perform multiple commands that are
specified in a file.
The batch command receives a text file with one or more command operations as input. The
text file is in the following format:
commandName [commandParameters]
Each line in the text file is interpreted as a command. When the batch command runs
successfully, the system returns output that corresponds to the successful execution of each
command that is listed in the input file to your display.
Example 5-6 instructs the system to run all of the commands that are contained in the
todays_batch.txt file.
bulkAssignDataCartridges
Use the bulkAssignDataCartridges command to assign cartridges in bulk to a logical library,
rather than assigning cartridges one at a time. You can bulk-assign up to 100 cartridges to a
common logical library.
This command receives a text file with one or more assign operations as input. Each line in
the file is interpreted as an assign operation. The input file is in the following format,
[F,C,R,T] #1 or VOLSER, as shown in Example 5-7. F = frame, C = column, R = row, and
T = tier.
The logical library name (assignment destination) is the same for all of the entries.
Example 5-8 instructs the system to execute the assignment of the cartridges that are
contained in the todays_bulk_assigns.txt file.
bulkAssignDataCartridgesByLL
Use the bulkAssignDataCartridgesByLL command to assign, in bulk, cartridges from a
common logical library source to multiple logical library destinations. The
bulkAssignDataCartridgesByLL command is faster than the bulkAssignDataCartridges
command because the system needs to search in only one logical library source.
This command receives a text file with one or more assign operations as input. Each line in
the file is interpreted as an assign operation. The input file is in the following format:
[F,C,R,T] #1, or VOLSER and the destination logical library name, as shown in Example 5-9.
cleanDrive
Use the cleanDrive command to clean a specific drive.
Each drive location must be delimited by a comma. However, do not insert commas between
the frame #, column #, and row #. The number sign (#) variables in the syntax have the
following values, a space is required between the delimiter:
-f# Frame number of the drive to update
-c# Column number of the drive to update
-r# Row number of the drive to update
codeUpdate
Use the codeUpdate command to update the library firmware. (To update the firmware in a
specific drive, use the driveCodeUpdate command or use the TS4500 management GUI.)
When the codeUpdate command executes successfully, the system returns output to your
display, as shown in Example 5-12.
continueCloseLibraryVerify
Use the continueCloseLibraryVerify command to finish the library verification process for
I/O stations. Before you run this command, you must run the continueLibraryVerify
command and then close all of the I/O station doors. (Library verification is a three-step
process in which the following commands must be run in this order: startLibraryVerify,
continueLibraryVerify, and continueCloseLibraryVerify.)
continueLibraryVerify
Use the continueLibraryVerify command to perform the second step of the library
verification process for I/O stations. Before you run this command, you must run the
startLibraryVerify command and then open all of the I/O station doors. (Library verification
is a three-step process in which the following commands must be run in this order:
startLibraryVerify, continueLibraryVerify, and continueCloseLibraryVerify.)
createBEP
Use the createBEP command to create the cartridges’ bar code encryption policy (BEP). You
must run the viewKeyLabelMapping command before you run the createBEP command to see
the key label mapping index number of the cartridges for the encryption policy.
Example 5-15 creates the cartridges’ bar code encryption policy for the VOLSER range
TT2000 - TT3000 in the test1 logical library for the 3592 cartridges, which are referenced in
index 1.
createKeyLabelMapping
Use the createKeyLabelMapping command to create a key label mapping.
When the createKeyLabelMapping command runs successfully, the system returns output to
your display. See Example 5-16, which instructs the system to create a mapping from the key
label START to the key label END by using the wrapped-hash key mode.
createLL
Use the createLL command to create a new logical library. Library name and the Drive Media
Type associated with the Library to be specified.
When the createLL command runs successfully, the system returns output to the display, as
shown in Example 5-17
createUser
Use the createUser command to create user names, roles, and a temporary password, if
required.
When the createUser command runs successfully, the system returns output to the display,
as shown in Example 5-18.
createVolserRanges
Use the createVolserRanges command to create one or more VOLSER ranges. This task is a
long-running task. The CLI shows the percentage of task completion while the task
progresses.
The createVolserRanges command receives a text file with one or more VOLSER ranges as
input. Each line of the input file is interpreted as a VOLSER range. The input file is in the
following format:
startRange,endRange,LLName,mediaType,Enable
While each line of the input file runs successfully and each VOLSER range is created, the
system returns the results to your display.
Example 5-20 uses the input file to instruct the system to create the VOLSER range that
starts with UAA9RH and ends with UBB9RH in logical library 1 for the 3592 frame. This VOLSER
range is not enabled for new cartridges.
deleteBEP
Use the deleteBEP command to delete a cartridge bar code encryption policy. You must run
the viewBEP command before you run this command to see the list of valid indexes.
Example 5-21 shows a command that instructs the system to delete the BEP for index 1. It is
necessary to run the viewBEP command before you run the deleteBEP command to see the
index number.
deleteKeyLabelMapping
Use the deleteKeyLabelMapping command to delete a key label mapping. You must run the
viewKeyLabelMapping command before you run this command to see the index of the key
label mapping that you want to delete.
deleteLL
The command deleteLL deletes a specific logical library
deleteUser
The deleteUser command delete local user accounts. After deletion, the account cannot be
used for authentication to the TS4500 management GUI or CLI.
deleteUser -username
deleteVolserRanges
Use the deleteVolserRanges command to delete VOLSER ranges. This task is a long-running
task.
The deleteVolserRanges command receives a text file with one or more VOLSER ranges as
input. Each line of the input file is interpreted as a VOLSER range to delete. The input file is in
the following format: LLName,startRange,endRange. Consider the following points regarding
the input file:
LLName is the name of the logical library.
startRange is the starting VOLSER in the range to delete.
endRange is the ending VOLSER in the range to delete.
Example 5-25 shows an example of a deleteVolserRanges input file. The example input file
instructs the system to delete the VOLSER that starts with TUU9RH and ends with TXX9RH from
logical library 1.
destageDataCartridges
Use the destageDataCartridges command to move cartridges from their cartridge cache
locations as specified in a text file or by using a list of VOLSERs to a high-density slot. This
command requires that all data cartridges that are being destaged are in tier 0.
The destageDataCartridges function can use a text file with one or more destage operations
as input. The filename.txt variable specifies the file name of the input file. The text file is in
one of the following formats:
From a storage location: [F,C,R,T]
VOLSER: [VOLSER]
Each line in the text file is interpreted as a prestage operation. In the text file, the data
cartridge location can be specified with the [F,C,R,T] location or the VOLSER.
Note: All source cartridges that are being destaged must be in tier 0 (T0).
Example 5-27 shows a destageDataCartridges input file with the F,C,R,T reference.
When the downloadEvents command runs successfully, the system returns output to the
display, as shown in Example 5-30.
downloadLog
Use the downloadLog command to download a .zip file with the logs from all node cards. This
command is useful for troubleshooting.
The downloadLog command does not have any required parameters. It downloads all of the
logs for all of the libraries. When the command runs successfully, the system returns output to
your display, as shown in Example 5-31.
downloadDrivesLog
Use the downloadDrivesLog command to download a .zip file containing the logs from the
specified (or all) drives This command is useful for troubleshooting.
Specify the drive locations of the drives, that you want to retrieve logs from. You can select to
download all drives at the same time. Each drive location must be delimited by a comma.
However, do not insert commas between the frame #, column #, and row #. The number sign
(#) variables in the syntax have the following values:
F# Frame number of the drive to update
C# Column number of the drive to update
R# Row number of the drive to update
All All drives
downloadPropertiesFile
Use the downloadPropertiesFile command to download the properties file (IBM TotalStorage
System Console (TSSC) file).
The downloadPropertiesFile does not have any required parameters. When the command
executes successfully, the system returns output to your display, as shown in Example 5-33.
downloadResources
Use the downloadResoruces command to export detailed information about all resources of a
specific type for this library. This information is saved as a .csv file. The format of this file
matches the exported table information from the management GUI.
downloadResources
<LogicalLibraries,Drives,FibreChannelPorts,iSCSIPorts,Slots,Cartridges,VOLSERRange
s,Users,Roles,ManagementEthernetPorts>
The file that is generated by microcode is saved to the working directory where the CLI is
running. The name of this file should use the following format:
<lib name>_<lib S/N>_<resource_type>_<timestamp>.csv
downloadSnapshot
Use the downloadSnapshot command to display a list of all available snapshots in the library.
You must run the viewSnapshots command before you run the downloadSnapshot command to
display a current list of indexes.
The index is the index number of the snapshot to download. (The index numbers are
displayed with the viewSnapshots command.)
The snapshot file is downloaded to the same directory where the CLI is running. When the
downloadSnapshot command runs successfully, the system returns output to your display, as
shown in Example 5-35.
driveCodeUpdate
Use the driveCodeUpdate command to update the firmware in a specified drive or specified
list of drives.
The list of drives that you want to update must be preceded by an -l. Specify the drive
locations of the drives that you want to update. Each drive location must be delimited by a
comma. However, do not insert commas between the frame #, column #, and row #. The
number sign (#) variables in the syntax have the following values:
F# Frame number of the drive to update
C# Column number of the drive to update
R# Row number of the drive to update
--reset Reset method for the drive after the code is updated
When the command runs successfully, the driveCodeUpdate command instructs the system
to update the drives in the list. The system returns output to your display. Example 5-36
shows that the system is instructed to update the drives in frame 1, column 4, row 2, and
frame 1, column 4, row 3 by using the code update that is contained in the
TS4500_1100-O4Q.afwz file.
editKeyLabelMapping
Use the editKeyLabelMapping command to edit a key label mapping. You must run the
viewKeyLabelMapping command before you run this command to see the index of the key
label mapping that you want to edit. The command uses this syntax:
editKeyLabelMapping index,keyLabelFrom,keyModeFrom,keyLabelTo
encrypt
Use the encrypt command to create an encrypted password that can be used with any other
CLI command. When using an encrypted password in a command, use -ep instead of -p
before the password.
In this example, the command encrypted the password AdminPW1 and the TS4500 responded
with an encrypted version of this password; therefore, any command after this can use the
encrypted version. As shown in Example 5-39, the encrypted password xEeUtEr9 is used with
the -ep parameter to run the viewSystemSummary command.
getFWVersion
Use the getFWVersion command to return the FW version installed in the library.
When the getFWVersion command runs successfully, the system returns output to the display
that is shown in Example 5-40
getFWVersion
Firmware Version: 1.5.0.1-601.00
The following values are valid for the Density code setting:
No advanced setting = 0
Show encryption = 1
Mask encryption = 2
modifyBEP
Use the modifyBEP command to edit the cartridges’ bar code encryption policy. You must run
the viewKeyLabelMapping and the viewBEP commands before you run this command to see
the list of valid indexes.
When the modifyBEP command runs successfully, the system returns output to your display.
Example 5-42 shows the command that updates the cartridges’ bar code encryption policy in
BEP index 1 and key label mapping index 3 with BEP not enabled.
modifyFibreChannelSettings
Use the modifyFibreChannelSettings command to set the ports’ speed and topology for a
specified drive. The speed and topology are the same for both ports in the drive.
The number sign (#) variables in the syntax have the following values:
-f# Frame number of the drive that contains ports 1 and 2
-c# Column number of the drive that contains ports 1 and 2
-r# Row number of the drive that contains ports 1 and 2
modifyVolserRanges
Use the modifyVolserRanges command to modify VOLSER ranges.
The modifyVolserRanges command receives a text file with one or more VOLSER ranges as
input. Each line of the input file is interpreted as a VOLSER range to modify.
The startRange parameter and the endRange parameter are used to get the range index in the
logical library table. These values cannot be modified.
Example 5-44 shows an input file that instructs the system to modify the VOLSER that starts
with UAA9RH and ends with UBB9RH in logical library 1 for the 3592 frame. As a result of the
TRUE flag for the Enable parameter, the VOLSER range is enabled for new cartridges.
Example 5-45 shows an example of the modifyVolserRanges command. Although each line of
the input file runs successfully and each VOLSER range is created, the system returns the
results to your display.
modifyVolserReporting
Use the modifyVolserReporting command to set whether the VOLSER is reported to the host
in a 6-character format or an 8-character format.
When this command runs successfully, the system returns the results of the
modifyVolserReporting operation to your display. In Example 5-46, the
modifyVolserReporting operation instructs the system to modify the VOLSER reporting to
the host for the cartridges in Library1 to a 6-character format.
moveFromAllDrives
Use the moveFromAllDrives command to eject all cartridges from all full drives and move
them to the home storage location. If the home storage location is unavailable, the
moveFromAllDrives command moves the cartridge to the first empty slot. (If you want to eject
a cartridge from a specific drive, use the moveFromDrive command.)
This command does not require any parameters. It performs the eject function for all of the
cartridges in all of the drives where cartridges are mounted.
When the moveFromAllDrives command runs successfully, the system returns output to your
display, as shown in Example 5-47.
moveFromDrive
Use the moveFromDrive command to eject a single cartridge from a drive and move it to the
home storage location. If the home storage location is unavailable, the moveFromDrive
command moves the cartridge to the first empty slot. (If you want to eject a cartridge from the
drive, and move it to a specific location, use the moveToDrive command.)
The number sign (#) variables in the syntax specify the drive where the cartridge is located
before you eject it. The variables have the following values:
-f# Frame number of the moveFrom location
-c# Column number of the moveFrom location
-r# Row number of the moveFrom location
When the moveFromDrive command successfully executes, and the cartridge is successfully
unmounted from the drive, the system returns output to your display. Example 5-48 on
page 348 shows that the system is instructed to eject the cartridge from the drive in frame 1,
column 4, row 1, and place it in a storage slot.
moveToDrive
Use the moveToDrive command to move a cartridge from a specified location to another
specified location.
You must first specify the drive location of the cartridge that you want moved. Then, specify
the destination where you want to move the cartridge.
The number sign (#) variables in the syntax have the following values:
F# Frame number of the drive for the moveFrom location
C# Column number of the drive for the moveFrom location
R# Row number of the drive for the moveFrom location
T# Tier number of the drive for the moveFrom location
-f# Frame number of the drive for the moveTo location
-c# Column number of the drive for the moveTo location
-r# Row number of the drive for the moveTo location
Note: The CLI is not case-sensitive. In the moveToDrive command, uppercase and
lowercase letters are used to distinguish between the moveFrom location and the moveTo
location.
When the moveToDrive command successfully runs and the cartridge is successfully mounted
in the new location, the system returns output to your display.
Example 5-49 shows the command that instructs the system to move the cartridge in drive F1,
C5, R1, T1 to the drive in f1, c4, r1. If the cartridge destination is in the same tier as the
moveFrom location, you do not need to specify the tier number in the moveTo location.
prestageDataCartridges
Use the prestageDataCartridges command to move cartridges from the high-density slots to
cartridge cache locations, as specified in a text file or by using a list of VOLSERs. All data
cartridges that are being prestaged must be in tier 3 or higher.
The prestageDataCartridges command can use a text file with one or more prestage
operations as input. The filename variable specifies the file name of the input file.
Each line in the text file is interpreted as a prestage operation. In the text file, the data
cartridge location can be specified with the [F,C,R,T] location or the VOLSER.
Note: All cartridges that are being prestaged must be in tier 3 or higher.
Example 5-50 shows a prestageDataCartridges input file with the F,C,R,T reference.
Example 5-50 The prestageDataCartridges input file with the F,C,R,T reference
F1,C2,R8,T3
F1,C3,R18,T5
Example 5-51 shows the prestageDataCartridges input file with the VOLSER reference.
Example 5-51 The prestageDataCartridges input file with the VOLSER reference
UAA9RHL7
UBB9RHL7
When the prestageDataCartridges command runs successfully, the system returns output to
your display.
Example 5-52 shows the command that instructs the system to prestage the data cartridges
to the correct library location based on the information that is specified in the prestage.txt
file.
removeDataCartridges
Use the removeDataCartridges command to remove the data cartridges from a storage
location to the I/O station. If VIO is enabled for a particular cartridge, the
removeDataCartridges command does not move the cartridge to the I/O station. It marks the
cartridge as a cartridge that is ready for export. The cartridge appears as unassigned. If VIO
is disabled, the cartridge moves to the I/O station.
The removeDataCartridges command receives a text file with one or more remove operations
as input. The text file is in the following format:
[F,C,R,T]
VOLSER
Example 5-54 shows the command that instructs the system to remove the data cartridges
from a storage slot to the I/O station based on the information in the todays_removes.txt file.
Example 5-54 shows the removeDataCartridges output.
resetDrive
Use the resetDrive command to power-cycle a specific drive.
The number sign (#) variables specify the location of the drive and feature the following
values:
-f# Frame number of the drive
-c# Column number of the drive
-r# Row number of the drive
When the resetDrive command runs successfully, the system returns output to your display,
as shown in Example 5-55.
resetNodeCards
Use the resetNodeCards command to reset one or more specified node cards.
Note: There is no warning to cancel; therefore, use this command with care because
running this command immediately resets the selected node card.
When the resetNodeCards command runs successfully, the system returns output to your
display. Example 5-56 shows the command where the system is instructed to reset the node
cards in nodes LCA1, LCAB3, and ACCA.
restoreConfiguration
Use the restoreConfiguration command to restore the configuration database to the library.
The configuration file (configuration.db) is uploaded to the library.
You must specify the name of a configuration file to upload. The file name can be any name
that you choose, but the file must have a .db extension. If the file is stored in the same
directory where you are running the CLI, you do not need to enter a path name for the file.
However, if the file is stored in a different directory, it is necessary to enter a path name for
the file.
When the restoreConfiguration command runs successfully, the system returns the result of
the operation to your display, as shown in Example 5-57.
No parameters are necessary. When the saveConfiguration command runs successfully, the
system returns the result of the operation to your display, as shown in Example 5-58.
setAccessorZones
This command is for use on Dual accessor libraries on and used to specify which tape drives
and I/O stations (within sets of frames) are served by which accessor. This command can
also be used to deactivate an accessor.
By default, each accessor is zoned to serve half of the frames in the library. Therefore, in a
12-frame library, Accessor A serves frames 1 - 6 and Accessor B serves frames 7 - 12.
You can view the current accessor zone settings by using the viewAccessorZones command.
You can also view these settings in the TS4500 management GUI in the Settings →
Library → Cartridges and Accessors page. The Accessor Preferred Zones graphic is
refreshed to reflect changes made both through the GUI and with the setAccessorZones
command.
Elastic capacity settings made through the Cartridges and Accessors page are unaffected by
zone changes made with the setAccessorZones command.
Use the no parameter to specify a different zone setting for an accessor, or to inactivate an
accessor. The use of this command to inactivate an accessor is the same as inactivating it in
the Cartridges and Accessors GUI page.
The example that is shown in Example 5-60 restricts Accessor A to frames 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5.
Accessor B serves the rest of the frames in the library.
setAutoEjectCleaningCarts
Use the setAutoEjectCleaningCarts command to set the enabled or disabled flag for the
auto eject expired cleaning cartridges function in the library.
setDrivePortsId
Use the setDrivePortsId command to set the ports’ IDs for a specified drive (Port 1 and
Port 2).
The number sign (#) variables in the syntax have the following values:
-f# Frame number of the drive that contains ports 1 and 2.
-c# Column number of the drive that contains ports 1 and 2.
-r# Row number of the drive that contains ports 1 and 2.
When the setDrivePortsId command runs successfully, the system returns the result of the
operation to your display, as shown in Example 5-62.
The number sign (#) variables in the syntax have the following values:
-f# Frame number of the drive.
-c# Column number of the drive.
-r# Row number of the drive.
When the setDriveUse command runs successfully, the system returns the result of the
operation to the display, as shown in Example 5-63.
setISCSI
The setISCSI command updates the network configuration settings for a single Ethernet drive
and to optionally change the name and alias of the drive. Each port can be configured
separately with this command, whereas network changes that are made through the TS4500
management GUI are always applied to both ports.
To look up a drive’s current settings, use the viewISCSI command or refer to the Drives →
Ethernet Ports GUI page
As shown in Example 5-64, the use of the command enables DHCP for port 0 of the drive in
F1C4R1 and renames the drive to new-drive-name.
As shown in Example 5-65, the use of the command disables DHCP for port 0 of the drive in
F1C4R1. It also assigns the address 9.1.2.4 to port 0 and also assigns the provided subnet
mask and gateway to the port.
As shown in Example 5-66, the use of the command enables DHCP for port 0 and disables
DHCP for port 1 of the drive in F1C4R1, and changes the alias for the drive to
new-drive-alias.
setLibraryTime
The setLibraryTime command takes the date, time, and time zone in the server where the
CLI is running and sets the library with those parameters.
No parameters are necessary. When the setLibraryTime command runs successfully, the
system returns the result of the operation to your display, as shown in Example 5-67.
When the setMacAddress command runs successfully, the system returns the result of the
operation to your display, as shown in Example 5-68. This example shows both accepted
formats of the MAC address.
setMaximumVIOCartridges
Use the setMaximumVIOCartridges command to update the number of virtual I/O slots for the
logical library.
The maximum number of cartridges can be any value 32 - 255. When this command runs
successfully, the system returns the results of the setMaximumVIOCartridges operation to your
display.
Example 5-69 shows the command to set the maximum virtual I/O cartridges in Library1
to 200.
When the setNMADetection command runs successfully, the system returns the result of the
operation to your display, as shown in Example 5-70.
setRolePermissions
Use the setRolePermissions command with the output from the viewRolePermissions
command. This command instructs the system to change the permissions for a specified role.
The setRolePermissions command receives a text file (which was created by the
viewRolepermissions command) as input. Each line in the text file is interpreted as an
instruction to set a permission. The text file can be edited to change any of the access levels
for the listed pages.
You can edit the text file to contain only the names of the web pages and permissions to
change.
Example 5-71 shows the input file that was originally generated by the viewRolePermissions
command. In this case, the input file is unchanged. However, you can edit the input file to
contain only the specific permissions to change with the setRolePermissions command.
When the setRolePermissions command runs successfully, the system returns output to your
display. Example 5-72 shows the command that instructs the system to set the role
permissions for the administrator role, according to information in the
administrator_permissions.txt file.
setScannerSpeed
Use the setScannerSpeed command to set the speed of the scanner.
setSlotOffline
Use the setSlotOffline command to set a storage slot offline.
The number sign (#) variables are defined in the following manner:
-f# Frame number of the slot
-c# Column number of the slot
-r# Row number of the slot
Note: When you use r =0, all rows for the specific column are set offline.
When the setSlotOffline command runs successfully, the system returns output to your
display. Example 5-74 shows that the command was successful.
setSlotOnline
Use the setSlotOnline command to set a storage slot online.
The number sign (#) variables are defined in the following manner:
-f# Frame number of the slot
-c# Column number of the slot
-r# Row number of the slot
Note: When you use r =0, all rows for the specific column are set online.
When the setSlotOnline command runs successfully, the system returns output to your
display. Example 5-75 shows that the command was successful.
When the setSSL command runs successfully, the system returns output to your display.
Example 5-76 shows the command that instructs the system to set the SSL flag to enabled.
setUtilThreshold
Use the setUtilThreshold command to change the default values of the Capacity Utilization
Threshold and the Dual Accessor Utilization Threshold.
If the number of cartridges exceeds the defined capacity utilization threshold, the Capacity
POD in the monitor system page turns yellow. If this scenario occurs, it is possible to remove
cartridges, increase capacity threshold, or purchase more capacity. By using this command,
you can increase or decrease the value where the alert occurs.
The dual accessor utilization threshold (-daut) option is only applicable to the dual accessor
libraries with elastic capacity enabled. It determines the threshold at which cartridges are
moved to accessor service areas in the end frames. The default for DAUT is 98% and CUT is
99%.
The -cut, -daut, or both options can be used. Consider the following points:
-daut values must be 90 - 100. Decimal places are not supported.
The following -cut values can be used:
– 50, 55, 60, 65, 70, 75, 80, 85, and 90
– 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, and 98
– 99.0, 99.1, 99.2, 99.3, 99.4, 99.5, 99.6, 99.7, 99.8, and 99.9
When the setUtilThreshold command runs successfully, the system returns output to the
display, as shown in Example 5-77.
showQueuedExports
Use the showQueuedExports command to set a flag to show or hide the list of queued exports.
This command is useful to view the status of the recent export jobs, cancel active jobs, or
remove any recent jobs from the list.
A flag value of true shows the queued exports list. A flag value of false hides the queued
exports list.
When this command runs successfully, the system returns the results of the
showQueuedExports operation to your display. Example 5-78 shows the command that shows
the queued exports list for the Library1 logical library.
startInventory
Use the startInventory command to start the library inventory process.
To only audit tier 0 and 1 select --audit FIRST parameter. The --audit ALL parameter will do
an inventory with full audit, so take care when to use this as it can take up to 45 minutes per
frame to complete.
When the startInventory command runs successfully, the system returns output to the
display, as shown in Example 5-79.
startCalibration
Use the startCalibration command to start calibration of the library, or components inside
the library.
When the startCalibration command runs successfully, the system returns output to the
display, as shown in Example 5-80.
When the startLibraryVerify command runs successfully, the system returns output to the
display, as shown in Example 5-79.
unassignDrive
Use the unassignDrive command to unassign a specific drive.
unassignDrive F#C#R#
The number sign (#) variables are defined in the following manner:
-f# Frame number of the drive
-c# Column number of the drive
-r# Row number of the drive
When the unassignDrive command runs successfully, the system returns output to the
display, as shown in Example 5-82.
version
Use the version command to view the current version of the Gen 4 TS4500 Web Interface
CLI program.
When the version command runs successfully, the system returns output to your display, as
shown in Example 5-83 on page 363.
viewAccessor
Use the viewAccessor command to show the accessor’s status and usage statistics. This
command has no parameters.
When the viewAccessor command runs successfully, the system returns output to your
display, as shown in Example 5-84.
Usage Statistics
, Accessor A Component
Pivots, 195
Gripper 1 gets, 5
Gripper 1 puts, 5
Gripper 2 gets, 1
Gripper 2 puts, 1
Bar code scans, 9355
X travel (meters), 112
Y travel (meters), 138
viewAccessorZones
Use the viewAccessorZones command to view which tape drives and I/O stations (within sets
of frames) are served by which accessor. You can also view these settings in the TS4500
management GUI in the Settings → Library → Cartridges and Accessors page.
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-85 on
page 364.
viewAdvancedEncryptionSettings
Use the viewAdvancedEncryptionSettings command to view high-level information for the
encryption settings for a specific logical library.
viewBEP
Use the viewBEP command to show a list of all VOLSER ranges that shows the bar code
encryption policy (BEP) settings. This command has no parameters.
When the viewBEP command runs successfully, the system returns output to your display, as
shown in Example 5-87.
viewCleaningCartridges
Use the viewCleaningCartridges command to view high-level information for all cleaning
cartridges in a library.
The viewCleaningCartridges command does not require any parameters. It instructs the
system to display information for all of the cleaning cartridges in the library. When the
viewCleaningCartridges command runs successfully, the system returns output to your
display.
The same command can generate a .csv file that is downloaded into the directory of the
TS4500CLI.jar file. Enter a name as a parameter to the command for the file that is
generated, as shown in the following example:
viewCleaningCartridges > any_name_you_want.csv
No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another directory, specify the
name of the directory in the command. The command is shown in Example 5-89.
Note: All view commands can generate a .csv file by adding the > any_name_you_want.csv
parameter at the end of the command.
viewDataCartridges
Use the viewDataCartridges command to view the high-level information for all data
cartridges in a library.
The viewDataCartridges command does not require any parameters. It lists the information
for all data cartridges in the library. When the viewDataCartridges command runs
successfully, the system returns output to your display. The output file sorts the names of the
data cartridges by VOLSER, as shown in Example 5-90.
You can use the viewDataCartridges command to instruct the system to generate a .csv file
from the output by typing a name as a parameter to the command for the file that is
generated.
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-91.
Note: All view commands can generate a .csv file by adding the > any_name_you_want.csv
parameter at the end of the command.
viewDriveDetails
The viewDriveDetails command provides a display of key information about the drive that is
useful for troubleshooting. It displays the contents of the drive, name of the logical library,
worldwide node numbers (WWNNs), port ID information, and so on.
The number sign (#) variables specify the location of the drive, and have the following values:
-f# Frame number of the drive
-c# Column number of the drive
-r# Row number of the drive
When the viewDriveDetails command runs successfully, the system returns output to your
display, as shown in Example 5-92.
The viewDriveDetails command includes a parameter that instructs the system to generate
a .csv file from the output. Enter a name as a parameter to the command for the file that is
generated, as shown in the following example:
viewDriveDetails > any_name_you_want.csv
Note: All view commands generate a .csv by adding the > any_name_you_want.csv
parameter at the end of the command.
viewDrivePod
Use the viewDrivePod command to display the drive portion of the status Pods. Pods in the
bottom of the GUI System page show a quick view of capacity, drive utilization, and library
health status. This pod is for drive status.
This command does not require any parameters. It lists a summary of information for all
drives in the library. When the viewDrivePod runs successfully, the system returns output to
the display, as shown in Example 5-94.
[{"clazz":"com.ibm.storage.anaconda.events.DriveStationEvent","drivesInUse":0,"lib
raryIdx":-1,"libraryName":"","podStatus":"HEALTHY","totalDrives":12,"topic":"DRIVE
_STATION","id":70800,"arguments":null,"timestamp":1538729795448,"topic":"DRIVE_STA
TION"}]
Note: All view commands generate a .csv by adding the > any_name_you_want.csv
parameter at the end of the command.
viewDriveSummary
Use the viewDriveSummary command to show all of the drives in the library. This summary
information is useful to network administrators who decide where to mount a cartridge. If you
want to list detailed information about a specific drive, use the viewDriveDetails command.
The viewDriveSummary command can include a parameter that instructs the system to
generate a .csv file from the output. Enter a name as a parameter to the command for the file
that is generated, as shown in the following example:
viewDriveSummary > any_name_you_want.csv
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-96.
viewDriveVPD
Use the viewDriveVPD command to show vital product data (VPD) information for all drives.
The viewDriveVPD command is useful if an administrator or IBM service support
representative (SSR) needs to see information, such as a product model number, product
release level, or other information that is specific to the device type.
The viewDriveVPD command does not require any parameters. It lists all of the vital product
data for all of the drives in the library.
When the viewDriveVPD command runs successfully, the system returns output to your
display, as shown in Example 5-97.
viewDriveVPD
Location(F,C,R), Drive Type,Firmware Version, Machine Type, Serial number
F1, C4, R1, 3592-E07, 38A7 , 3592, 00013B008E
F1, C4, R4, 3592-E07, 38A7 , 3592, 00013B006
The viewDriveVPD command can include a parameter that instructs the system to generate a
.csv file from the output. Enter a name as a parameter to the command for the file that is
generated, as shown in the following example:
viewDriveVPD > any_name_you_want.csv
viewEventTable
Use the viewEventTable command to display the last seven events logged. Only Library
events show no service events, such as “calibrate frame”, and audit events, such as “user
logged in”.
The viewEventTable command does not require any parameter. Because this output is large,
save this output to a .csv file, as shown in Example 5-99.
Example 5-99 The viewEventTable command (truncated to one event for better visibilty)
viewEventTable > eventable.csv
Figure 5-2 shows example of the output from the .csv file that is created.
Note: All view commands generate a .csv by adding the > any_name_you_want.csv
parameter at the end of the command.
Use the viewFibreChannel command to show the Fibre Channel settings for both ports in
each drive. This command is useful to view the configuration of the ports for the Fibre
Channel switch and to ensure that the ports are configured correctly to be compatible with the
type of network in use.
The viewFibreChannel command does not require any parameters. When the
viewFibreChannel command runs successfully, the system returns output to your display. The
output file sorts the information by drive name, as shown in Example 5-100.
The viewFibreChannel command can include a parameter that instructs the system to
generate a .csv file from the output. Type a name, as a parameter to the command, for the file
that is generated:
viewFibreChannel > any_name_you_want.csv
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-101.
viewIoStation
Use the viewIoStation command to view a summary of information for all cartridges in the
I/O station.
Use the viewIoStation command (and all view commands) to instruct the system to generate
a .csv file from the output. Enter a name as a parameter to the command for the file that is
generated, as shown in the following example:
viewIoStation > any_name_you_want.csv
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-103.
viewISCSI
Use the viewISCSI command to configuration settings for a specific Ethernet drive.
The number sign (#) variables specify the location of the drive, and have the following values:
-f# Frame number of the drive
-c# Column number of the drive
-r# Row number of the drive
When the viewISCSI command runs successfully, the system returns output to your display,
as shown in Example 5-104.
viewKeyLabelMapping
Use the viewKeyLabelMapping command to view the list of available key labels. The command
uses the following syntax:
viewKeyLabelMapping
The values in the Index column are referenced when you run the editKeyLabelMapping and
deleteKeyLabelMapping commands.
viewLibraryVPD
Use the viewLibraryVPD command to show VPD for the library. This command is useful if an
administrator or service engineer must see the model or serial number or other information
specific to the library. This command requires a service user to run.
When the viewLibraryVPD command runs successfully, the system returns output to your
display, as shown in Example 5-106.
The viewLibraryVPD command (and all view commands) can include a parameter that
instructs the system to generate a .csv file from the output. Enter a name as a parameter to
the command for the file that is generated, as shown in the following example:
viewLibraryVPD > any_name_you_want.csv
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-107.
viewLogicalLibraries
Use the viewLogicalLibraries command to list the high-level information for all logical
libraries. If you must list detailed information for a specific library, use the
viewLogicalLibraryDetails command.
Note: The Queued Exports information and the VOLSER Reporting information are
available only through the viewLogicalLibraryDetails command at the CLI. This
information is not available through the TS4500 management GUI.
The viewLogicalLibraries command can include a parameter that instructs the system to
generate a .csv file from the output. Enter a name as a parameter to the command for the file
that is generated, as shown in the following example:
viewLogicalLibraries > any_name_you_want.csv
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-109.
viewLogicalLibraryDetails
Use the viewLogicalLibraryDetails command to show the name, type, maximum number of
cartridges, number of virtual I/O slot addresses, and number of drive addresses in a specified
logical library.
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-111.
viewMacAddress
Use the viewMacAddress command to look up the MAC addresses for a drive's Ethernet ports.
The number sign (#) variables specify the location of the drive, and have the following values:
-f# Frame number of the drive
-c# Column number of the drive
-r# Row number of the drive
When the viewMacAddress command runs successfully, the system returns output to your
display, as shown in Example 5-112.
viewNodeCards
Use the viewNodeCards command to show a summary of information about the node cards.
The viewNodeCards command does not require any parameters. It lists the high-level
information for all node cards in the system. When the viewNodeCards command runs
successfully, the system returns output to your display, as shown in Example 5-113.
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-114.
viewOfflineComponents
Use the viewOfflineComponents command to show a list of offline slots.
The viewOfflineComponents command does not require any parameters. It lists all offline
storage slots. When the viewOfflineComponents command runs successfully, the system
returns output to your display, as shown in Example 5-115.
Use the viewOfflineComponents command to instruct the system to generate a .csv file from
the output. Enter a name as a parameter to the command for the file that is generated, as
shown in the following example:
viewOfflineComponents > any_name_you_want.csv
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-116.
viewPasswordAndSessionPolicy
Use the viewPasswordAndSessionPolicy command to display the settings for GUI Sessions
and the password characteristics set.
Automatic logout: 60
Password lock: 10 attempts
Automatic IMC (local GUI) login at power on: Disabled
Minimum number of characters: 8
Minimum number of upper case characters: 1
Minimum number of lower case characters: 1
Minimum number of numeric characters: 1
Minimum number of special characters: 0
Maximum identical consecutive characters: 2
Maximum password age: 90 day(s)
Minimum password age: 1 day(s)
Number of unique passwords before reusing: 8
viewRolePermissions
Use the viewRolePermissions command to display a list of all of the permissions for a
specified role. The output shows a list of the web pages in the library that are available to that
role, and the corresponding access level.
The filename.txt variable is optional. When you specify a file name, you instruct the system
to generate a .txt file that can be used with the setRolePermissions command. The system
generates the .txt file and stores it in the directory that contains the TS4500CLI.jar file. The
text file can be edited to change any of the access levels for the listed pages.
When the viewRolePermissions command runs successfully, the system returns output to
your display, as shown in Example 5-118.
viewRoles
Use the viewRoles command to display a list of all of the defined roles in the library.
The viewRoles command does not require any parameters. It instructs the system to display
information for all roles in the library. When the viewRoles command runs successfully, the
system returns output to your display, as shown in Example 5-119.
The viewRoles command can include a parameter that instructs the system to generate a
.csv file from the output. Enter a name as a parameter to the command for the file that is
generated.
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-120.
viewSnapshots
Use the viewSnapshots command to display a list of all available snapshots in the library. The
files in the list can be used with the downloadSnapshot command.
The viewSnapshots command does not require any parameters. It instructs the system to
display information for all available snapshots in the library. When the viewSnapshots
command runs successfully, the system returns output to your display, as shown in
Example 5-121.
The viewSnapshots command (and all view commands) can include a parameter that
instructs the system to generate a .csv file from the output. Enter a name as a parameter to
the command for the file that is generated:
viewSnapshots > any_name_you_want.csv
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-122.
viewStorageCapacity
Use the viewStorageCapacity command to view the licensed media types. It provides more
information about how each slot type (LTO / JAG) is licensed and how many slots are in use.
The viewStorageCapacity command does not require any parameters. When the command
runs successfully, the system returns output to your display, as shown in Example 5-123.
The viewSystemSummary command does not require any parameters. It lists the information
about each frame in ascending order by frame number. When the viewSystemSummary
command runs successfully, the system returns output to your display, as shown in
Example 5-124.
The viewSystemSummary command can instruct the system to generate a .csv file from the
output. Enter a name as a parameter to the command for the file that is generated, as shown
in the following example:
viewSystemSummary > any_name_you_want.csv
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-125 on
page 379.
The pound sign (#) variable in the command specifies the frame number of the frame for
which you want more information. If the input frame is not available in the library, the system
displays an error message.
When the viewSystemSummaryDetails command runs successfully, the system returns output
to your display, as shown in Example 5-126.
The viewSystemSummaryDetails command can instruct the system to generate a .csv file from
the output. Enter a name, as a parameter to the command for the file that is generated, as
shown in the following example:
viewSystemSummaryDetails > any_name_you_want.csv
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-127.
Note: The system does not display any information about accessors if the specified frame
does not have accessors.
The viewUsers command does not require any parameters. It instructs the system to display
information for all users in the library. When the viewUsers command runs successfully, the
system returns output to your display, as shown in Example 5-128.
The viewUsers command can include a parameter that instructs the system to generate a
.csv file from the output. Enter a name as a parameter to the command, for the file that
is generated, as shown in the following example:
viewUsers > any_name_you_want.csv
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-129.
viewUtilThreshold
Use the viewUtilThreshold command to see more information about the defined Capacity
Utilization Threshold and the Dual Accessor Utilization Threshold.
If the number of cartridges exceeds the defined capacity utilization threshold, the Capacity
POD in the monitor system page turns yellow. If this scenario occurs, remove the cartridges,
increase the capacity threshold, or purchase more capacity.
The dual accessor utilization threshold (-daut) option is applicable to dual accessor libraries
only with elastic capacity enabled. It determines the threshold in which cartridges are moved
to accessor service areas in the end frames. The default is 98%.
The viewUtilThreshold command does not require any parameters. When the
viewUtilThreshold command runs successfully, the system returns output to the display, as
shown in Example 5-130 on page 382.
viewVolserRanges
Use the viewVolserRanges command to list all of the VOLSER ranges in the physical library.
To list all of the VOLSER ranges that are assigned to each logical library, use the
viewVolserRangesByLL command.
The viewVolserRanges command does not require any parameters. It lists the information for
all of the VOLSER ranges in the physical library. When the viewVolserRanges command
executes successfully, the system returns output to your display, as shown in Example 5-131.
The viewVolserRanges command can include a parameter that instructs the system to
generate a .csv file from the output. Enter a name, as a parameter to the command, for the
file that is generated, as shown in the following example:
viewVolserRanges > any_name_you_want.csv
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-132.
viewVolserRangesByLL
Use the viewVolserRangesByLL command to list all of the VOLSER ranges for each logical
library in the physical library. To list all of the VOLSER ranges for the physical library, use the
viewVolserRanges command.
Use the viewVolserRangesByLL command to instruct the system to generate a .csv file from
the output. Enter a name as a parameter to the command for the file that is generated, as
shown in the following example:
viewVolserRangesByLL > any_name_you_want.csv
The system generates the .csv file and stores it in the directory that contains the
TS4500CLI.jar file. No message is returned to your display. To store the .csv file in another
directory, specify the name of the directory in the command, as shown in Example 5-134.
The publications that are listed in this section are particularly suitable for a more detailed
discussion of the topics that are covered in this book.
IBM Redbooks
The following IBM Redbooks publications provide more information about the topic in
this document. Note that some publications that are referenced in this list might be available
in softcopy only:
IBM Tape Library Guide for Open Systems, SG24-5946
IBM Spectrum Archive Enterprise Edition V1.2.6: Installation and Configuration Guide,
SG24-8333
IBM Linear Tape File System Installation and Configuration, SG24-8090
Implementing IBM Tape in Linux and Windows, SG24-6268
Implementing IBM Tape in UNIX Systems, SG24-6502
You can search for, view, download, or order these documents and other Redbooks,
Redpapers, Web Docs, draft, and other materials, at the following website:
ibm.com/redbooks
Other publications
The following publications are also relevant as further information sources:
IBM Tape Device Drivers Installation and User’s Guide, GC27-2130
http://www.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=ssg1S7002972
IBM TS4500 Introduction and Planning Guide, SC27-5990
http://www.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=ssg1S7005016
IBM TotalStorage Enterprise Tape System 3592 Introduction and Planning Guide,
GA32-0555
http://www.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=ssg1S7005233
IBM TotalStorage LTO Ultrium Tape Drive SCSI Reference (LTO-5 through LTO-8),
GA32-0928
http://www.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=ssg1S7003556
IBM 3592 SCSI Reference, GA32-0562
https://www.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=ssg1S7003248
IBM Tape System Library Manager User’s Guide, GA32-2208
http://www.ibm.com/support/docview.wss?uid=pub1ga32220802
SG24-8235-06
ISBN 0738457337
Printed in U.S.A.
®
ibm.com/redbooks